0
登录后你可以
  • 下载海量资料
  • 学习在线课程
  • 观看技术视频
  • 写文章/发帖/加入社区
会员中心
创作中心
发布
  • 发文章

  • 发资料

  • 发帖

  • 提问

  • 发视频

创作活动
DT13-12PA

DT13-12PA

  • 厂商:

    HUMIREL(泰科)

  • 封装:

  • 描述:

    针座连接器 面板安装,通孔,直角 12 位置 0.175"(4.44mm)

  • 详情介绍
  • 数据手册
  • 价格&库存
DT13-12PA 数据手册
INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION Terminals and Connectors INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Contents General Information About TE Connectivity................................................................... 2 TE.com.................................................................................................. 3 Introduction to Connectors.......................................................4-5 Connector Series Overview.................................................... 6-10 AMP Products AMPSEAL Connectors.............................................................11-20 AMPSEAL 16 Connectors.......................................................21-34 Circular DIN Connectors........................................................35-44 HDSCS Connectors.................................................................45-62 LEAVYSEAL Connectors....................................................... 63-78 Superseal 1.0 Connectors......................................................79-84 DEUTSCH Products AEC Series................................................................................. 85-90 DRB Series...................................................................................91-98 DRC Series................................................................................99-108 DT Family.................................................................................109-132 HD10 Series.............................................................................133-144 HD30 & HDP20 Series........................................................ 145-160 STRIKE Series.......................................................................... 161-168 Common Contacts............................................................... 169-180 Tooling........................................................................................181-190 Specialty Products Bussing Options.....................................................................191-194 Controller Area Networks.................................................195-207 Diodes & Resistors............................................................. 205-208 Printed Circuit Board Connectors................................209-222 Single Terminal..................................................................... 223-228 Additional Resources Modification List..................................................................230-238 Other TE Industrial & Commercial Transportation Products................................................................................ 239-240 Requirements & Standards........................................................ 241 Glossary.................................................................................. 242-247 Index........................................................................................ 248-252 TE Connectivity Industrial & Commercial Transportation We go to extremes to make sure EVERY CONNECTION COUNTS. TE Connectivity’s (TE) products are in nearly every high-tech product imaginable. From consumer electronics, health care, energy supply, and communication networks, to the transportation and aviation industries, TE’s extensive portfolio of over 500,000 products keep the world connected. TE’s intelligent and robust solutions and technologies carry over to the industrial and heavy duty vehicle markets. TE offers products that work just as hard as the vehicles in which they are installed. Years ago, tractors, construction equipment, trucks, and boats had simple electrical systems that might have included electrical starting and a basic lighting package. Today, ECUs, joysticks, fuel-efficient engines, LED lights, and CAN systems are standard equipment. The need to protect sensitive electrical systems from vibration, moisture, dust, dirt, salt and airborne particles has never been greater. TE Industrial & Commercial Transportation is a leader in supporting today’s increasingly complex and sophisticated equipment and applications. TE’s comprehensive line of Industrial & Commercial Transportation products include an unparalleled portfolio of rugged electrical connector products and sensor technologies. TE’s environmentally sealed connectors are designed to withstand the harshest environmental conditions and to keep vehicles moving forward. TE’s portfolio of heavy duty sensors help vehicles operate safer, cleaner, and smarter. From heavy duty trucks to construction equipment, mining vehicles to fire trucks, as well as boats, motorcycles, and tractors, leading manufacturers count on TE Industrial & Commercial Transportation. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS TE Connectivity Industrial & Commercial Transportation Online Resources The TE Connectivity Industrial & Commercial Transportation’s website is an innovative and interactive source for application information, product updates, and technical solutions. PRODUCT LITERATURE AND VIDEOS TE Industrial & Commercial Transportation offers a variety of product specific catalogs, brochures, and videos to better serve you. For more information on literature for TE Industrial & Commercial Transportation, please contact your representative or go to http://www.te.com/usa-en/industries/truck-bus-off-road-vehicles/ ictliterature.html To view videos about TE Industrial & Commercial Transportation, please go to http://www.te.com/usa-en/industries/truck-bus-off-road-vehicles/ ict-video-index.html TE INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION PRODUCTS For more information on TE Industrial & Commercial Transportation products, please go to http://www.te.com/usa-en/ industries/truck-bus-off-road-vehicles/products.html PRODUCT INFORMATION CENTER (PIC) You can rely on TE Connectivity’s PIC team to provide support for answers to your general information or technical questions in an efficient and effective manner. Connect with our PIC staff, http://www.te.com/usa-en/customer-support/ email.html PAGE 3 Introduction to Connectors In heavy industries, electrical systems must stand up to rigorous conditions and all weather environments. Failure in an electrical system can be expensive to diagnose and down equipment can stop entire operations. As equipment becomes increasingly sophisticated and reliant on electronic packaging and diagnostics, design engineers know the importance of choosing environmentally sealed electrical connectors capable of holding up to extreme conditions. Many manufacturers count on TE Connectivity Industrial & Commercial Transportation’s electrical connectors to maintain their electrical connections. Benefits of industrial connectors There are many different connectors for harsh environments and connector selection for each specific application is important. Once the questions of wire gauge and pin count have been addressed, the environmental challenges specific to each application must be identified, including if the electrical system will be exposed to heat, impact or vibration. Other elements that need to be addressed include if the connectors will be susceptible to moisture or chemicals and field serviceability. Developed with simplicity of design and ease of use in mind, TE connectors offer a variety of innovative solutions to suit nearly any application and stand up to environmental challenges. Whether for a new application or a retrofit, connectors provide simplified design and wiring, and easy field repairs. TE Industrial & Commercial Transportation’s connector applications include ECUs, joysticks, industrial and marine engines, control boxes, lights and CAN systems, just to mention a few. TE Industrial & Commercial Transportation’s connector series offer several features designed to combat environmental challenges. Connector features help protect electrical connections Connector bodies must be able to stand up to environmental conditions. Rugged all-metal bodies and corrosion resistant thermoplastic shells are manufactured from high quality materials selected for their ability to withstand years of environmental exposure. Metal connectors are built to withstand the force and shock of hard impacts that connectors face in rough environments. High-grade thermoplastic connectors are lightweight and are engineered to be flame resistant and extremely chemical resistant. Different connector body materials are available to meet diverse application requirements. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Introduction to Connectors Proper contact alignment is another important aspect of environmentally sealed electrical connectors. Secondary locks snap into or onto the mating face of a connector to help confirm the contacts slide together properly when the connectors are mated. Many of TE Industrial & Commercial Transportation’s connectors feature secondary locks that are commonly referred to as wedgelocks, terminal position assurance (TPA), or primary latch reinforcement (PLR). Wedgelocks, TPAs, and PLRs provide additional stability to both the contact barrel and the mated connectors. A firm, secure locking mechanism that can withstand vibration and shock is critical to maintain a steadfast connector engagement in rugged applications. TE Industrial & Commercial Transportation’s connectors are held together by push-latches, threaded coupling rings, or tightened together by jackscrews. The locking mechanisms are easy to engage and disengage and give an audible or tactile signal when they are securely fastened. Once fastened, the locking mechanisms prevent disengagement due to vibration or impact. Since even a small degradation in electrical connections can be critical to industrial vehicles, manufacturers are turning to TE Industrial & Commercial Transportation’s environmentally sealed electrical connectors to keep their equipment running. Connectors are increasingly needed as industrial equipment becomes more complex and reliant on electronic control units, CAN systems, and on-board communications systems. With a wide variety of industrial electrical connectors, manufacturers can find a connector for nearly any application. No matter the environment, TE’s industrial connectors provide the innovative solutions demanded by harsh conditions. TE’s dedication to quality and innovation has created a unique system of easy-to-use connectors to simplify processes from start to finish. PAGE 5 Connector Series Overview Connector Series Overview TE Connectivity connectors offer different shapes, latching mechanisms, mounting styles, and materials to meet diverse application requirements and offer accessories to further expand the series’ flexibility. Below is an overview of each connector series that highlights the cavity count, wire gauge, material, and locking mechanism style. For complete series information, please see the series section of the catalog. AEC Series • Accepts contact size 16 (13 amps) • 14-20 AWG (2.00-0.50 mm2) • 40 cavity arrangement • In-line • Square, thermoplastic housing • Jackscrew for mating AMPSEAL Connectors • Accepts contact size 1.3 mm (up to 17 amps gold, up to 8 amps tin) • 16-20 AWG (1.25-0.50 mm2) • 8, 14, 23, and 35 cavity arrangements • PCB mount • Rectangular, thermoplastic housing • Integrated latch for mating • Integrated wedgelock confirms contact alignment and retention • Product specification documents: 108-1329 and 114-16016 AMPSEAL 16 Connectors • Accepts contact size HDSF 16 (up to 13 amps) • 14-20 AWG (2.00-0.50 mm2) • 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, and 12 cavity arrangements • In-line mount • Rectangular, thermoplastic housing • Integrated latch for mating • Integrated Primary Latch Reinforcement (PLR) confirms contact alignment and retention • Product specification documents: 108-2184, 114-13045, and 114-13065 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Connector Series Overview Circular DIN Connectors • Accepts contact size 2.5 mm (up to 40 amps) • 2.50-0.20 mm2 • 2, 3, and 4 cavity arrangements • In-line, flange, or PCB mount • Circular, thermoplastic housing • Coupling ring for mating • Product specification documents: 108-18621 and 114-18255 DRB Series • Accepts contact sizes 4 (100 amps), 8 (60 amps), 12 (25 amps), 16 (13 amps), and 20 (7.5 amps) • 6-22 AWG (16.00-0.35 mm2) • 48, 60, 102, and 128 cavity arrangements • Flange mount • Rectangular, thermoplastic housing • Jackscrew for mating • Wedgelocks confirm contact alignment and retention DRC Series • Accepts contact sizes 16 (13 amps), and 20 (7.5 amps) • 14-22 AWG (2.50-0.35 mm2) • 24, 38, 40, 50, 60, 64, 70, and 76 cavity arrangements • In-line, flange, or PCB mount • Rectangular, thermoplastic housing • Jackscrew for mating DT Series • Accepts contact size 16 (13 amps) • 14-20 AWG (2.00-0.50 mm2) • 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, and 12 cavity arrangements • In-line, flange, or PCB mount • Rectangular, thermoplastic housing • Integrated latch for mating • Wedgelocks confirm contact alignment and retention • Product specification document: 108-151009 PAGE 7 Connector Series Overview DTHD Series • Accepts contact sizes 4 (100 amps), 8 (60 amps), and 12 (25 amps) • 6-14 AWG (16.00-2.00 mm2) • 1 cavity arrangement • In-line or flange mount • Circular, thermoplastic housing • Integrated latch for mating DTM Series • Accepts contact size 20 (7.5 amps) • 14-22 AWG (2.50-0.35 mm2) • 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, and 12 cavity arrangements • In-line, flange, or PCB mount • Rectangular, thermoplastic housing • Integrated latch for mating • Wedgelocks confirm contact alignment and retention • Product specification document: 108-151010 DTP Series • Accepts contact size 12 (25 amps) • 10-14 AWG (6.00-2.00 mm2) • 2 and 4 cavity arrangements • In-line, flange, or PCB mount • Rectangular, thermoplastic housing • Integrated latch for mating • Wedgelocks confirm contact alignment and retention DTV Series • Accepts contact size 16 (13 amps) • 14-20 AWG (2.00-0.50 mm2) • 18 cavity arrangement • Flange mount • Rectangular, thermoplastic housing • Integrated latch for mating • Wedgelocks confirm contact alignment and retention INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Connector Series Overview HD10 Series • Accepts contact sizes 4 (100 amps), 12 (25 amps), and 16 (13 amps) • 6-20 AWG (16.00-0.50 mm2) • 3, 4, 5, 6, and 9 cavity arrangements • In-line, flange, or PCB mount • Circular, thermoplastic housing • Coupling ring for mating HD30 Series • Accepts contact sizes 4 (100 amps), 8 (60 amps), 12 (25 amps), 16 (13 amps), and 20 (7.5 amps) • 6-22 AWG (13.00-0.35 mm2) • 2, 6, 8, 9, 14, 16, 18, 19, 20, 21, 23, 29, 31, 33, 35, and 47 cavity arrangements • In-line or flange mount • Circular, aluminum housing • Coupling ring for mating HDP20 Series • Accepts contact sizes 4 (100 amps), 8 (60 amps), 12 (25 amps), 16 (13 amps), and 20 (7.5 amps) • 4-22 AWG (25.00-0.35 mm2) • 2, 6, 7, 8, 9, 14, 16, 18, 19, 20, 21, 23, 29, 31, 33, 35, and 47 cavity arrangements • In-line or flange mount • Circular, thermoplastic housing • Coupling ring for mating HDSCS Connectors • Accepts contact sizes 6.3 (up to 40 amps), 2.8 (up to 40 amps), and 1.5K (up to 20 amps) • 6.00-0.20 mm2 • 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, 10, 12, 15, 16, and 18 cavity arrangements • In-line or flange mount • Rectangular, thermoplastic housing • Slide lock for mating • Integrated secondary lock confirms contact alignment and retention • Product specification documents: 108-94020 and 114-18756 PAGE 9 Connector Series Overview LEAVYSEAL Connectors • Accepts contact sizes 6.3 (up to 40 amps), 2.8 (up to 40 amps), and 1.5K (up to 20 amps) • 6.00-0.20 mm2 • 15, 18, 21, 22, 26, 29, 31, 39, 46, 62, and 92 cavity arrangements • In-line, flange, or PCB mount • Rectangular, thermoplastic housing • Lever for mating • Integrated secondary lock confirms contact alignment and retention • Product specification documents: 108-18696 and 114-18376 STRIKE Series • Accepts contact sizes 16 (13 amps) and 20 (7.5 amps) • 14-22 AWG (2.50-0.35 mm2) • 32 and 64 cavity arrangements • In-line, flange, or PCB mount • Square, thermoplastic housing • Lever for mating • TPA confirms contact alignment and retention Superseal 1.0 Connectors • Accepts contact size 1.0 mm (up to 15 amps) • 1.25-0.50 mm2 • 26, 34, and 60 cavity arrangements • PCB mount • Rectangular, thermoplastic housing • Integrated latch for mating • TPA confirms contact alignment and retention • Product specification documents: 108-78140 and 114-78011 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Contents AMPSEAL Connector Overview............................12 Product Documentation...........................................12 Performance Specifications....................................12 Material Specifications..............................................13 Dimensions....................................................................13 Configurations..............................................................13 Ordering Information................................................ 14 Accessories....................................................................15 Contacts...................................................................15-16 Tooling.............................................................................17 How To Instructions.............................................18-19 AMPSEAL Connectors AMPSEAL Connector Overview AMPSEAL connectors provide rugged reliability and environmental sealing. They are available in cable plugs and PCB mount headers that are designed to stand up to high-temperature underhood applications. The pre-assembled receptacle housing connector features built-in contact sealing and an integral interfacial seal that protects mated connectors. APPLICABLE PRODUCT DOCUMENTATION Additional documentation is available for assistance with AMPSEAL connector products. The following TE Connectivity document numbers may be helpful: 54285-2 (Catalog Section) 108-1329 (Product Specification) 114-16016 (Application Specification) 408-3229 (Instruction Sheet) 408-9592 (Instruction Sheet, Tooling) 408-9999 (Instruction Sheet, Tooling) AMPSEAL CONNECTOR PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Current: Up to 17 amps gold, up to 8 amps tin Temperature: Operating at temperatures -40°C to +125°C for gold plated, -40°C to +105°C for tin plated Durability: See note. Mate and unmate specimens for 10 cycles at maximum rate of 600 cycles per hour. Physical Shock: No discontinuities of 1 microsecond or longer duration. TE Spec 109-26-1. Subject mated specimens to 50 G’s half-sine shock pulses of 11 milliseconds duration. Three shocks in each direction applied along 3 mutually perpendicular planes, 18 total shocks. See Fig 5 in TE product document 108-1329. Insulation Resistance: 100 megohms minimum. TE Spec 109-28-4. Test between adjacent contacts of mated specimens. Immersion: Leakage current not to exceed 50 micro-amperes at 48 volts DC. TE Spec 109-74-5. Immerse specimens to a depth of 100 mm in 5% salt water at a temperature of 23 ± 5° C for 1 hour. Check between adjacent circuits and each surface to reference electrode. Random Vibration: See note. TE Spec 109-21-7, Condition G, except 10-500 Hz frequency range. Subject mated specimens to 10 Gs for 8 hours each plane. Voltage: 250 volts AC Note: Shall meet visual requirements, show no physical damage and shall meet requirements of additional tests as specified in Test Sequence in Figure 3 of TE product document 108-1329. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS AMPSEAL Connectors MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS Wire Seal: Silicone rubber Mating Seal: Silicone rubber Cover: Glass filled PBT Locking Wedge: PBT DIMENSIONS E B C A E F AMPSEAL Receptacle Housing F D G AMPSEAL Header Overall Length A Overall Height B Overall Width C Overall Length Straight D Overall Height E Overall Width F Overall Length 90° G 8 1.32 (33.6) 1.36 (34.6) 1.08 (27.4) 1.35 (34.3) 1.26 (32.1) 1.61 (40.8) 1.49 (37.9) 14 1.32 (33.6) 1.36 (34.6) 1.39 (35.4) 1.35 (34.3) 1.26 (32.1) 1.92 (48.8) 1.49 (37.9) 23 1.32 (33.6) 1.36 (34.6) 1.87 (47.4) 1.35 (34.25) 1.26 (32.1) 2.39 (60.8) 1.49 (37.9) 35 1.32 (33.6) 1.36 (34.6) 2.50 (63.4) 1.35 (34.25) 1.26 (32.1) 3.03 (76.9) 1.49 (37.9) Cavity Dimensions are for reference only. CONFIGURATIONS 8 Positions 8 size 1.3 mm 14 Positions 14 size 1.3 mm 23 Positions 23 size 1.3 mm 35 Positions 35 size 1.3 mm PAGE 13 AMPSEAL Connectors ORDERING INFORMATION Position Keyed Housing Color Black 8 Natural Black Natural 14 Gray Blue Black Natural 23 Gray Blue Black Natural 35 Gray Blue Orange Contact Finish Tin plated Gold plated Tin plated Gold plated Tin plated Gold plated Tin plated Gold plated Tin plated Gold plated Tin plated Gold plated Tin plated Gold plated Tin plated Gold plated Tin plated Gold plated Tin plated Gold plated Tin plated Gold plated Tin plated Gold plated Tin plated Gold plated Tin plated Gold plated Gold plated Receptacle Housing 776286-1 776286-2 776273-1 776273-2 776273-4 776273-5 770680-1 770680-2 770680-4 770680-5 776164-1 776164-2 776164-4 776164-5 776164-6 Right-Angle PCB Header Vertical PCB Header Without Seal With Seal Without Seal With Seal 776279-1 776280-1 776275-1 776276-1 1-776279-1 1-776280-1 1-776275-1 1-776276-1 776279-2 776280-2 776275-2 776276-2 1-776279-2 1-776280-2 1-776275-2 1-776276-2 776266-1 776267-1 776261-1 776262-1 1-776266-1 1-776267-1 1-776261-1 1-776262-1 776266-2 776267-2 776261-2 776262-2 1-776266-2 1-776267-2 1-776261-2 1-776262-2 776266-4 776267-4 776261-4 776262-4 1-776266-4 1-776267-4 1-776261-4 1-776262-4 776266-5 776267-5 776261-5 776262-5 1-776266-5 1-776267-5 1-776261-5 1-776262-5 770669-1 776087-1 776200-1 776228-1 1-770669-1 1-776087-1 1-776200-1 1-776228-1 770669-2 776087-2 776200-2 776228-2 1-770669-2 1-776087-2 1-776200-2 1-776228-2 770669-4 776087-4 776200-4 776228-4 1-770669-4 1-776087-4 1-776200-4 1-776228-4 770669-5 776087-5 776200-5 776228-5 1-770669-5 1-776087-5 1-776200-5 1-776228-5 776180-1 776163-1 776230-1 776231-1 1-776180-1 1-776163-1 1-776230-1 1-776231-1 776180-2 776163-2 776230-2 776231-2 1-776180-2 1-776163-2 1-776230-2 1-776231-2 776180-4 776163-4 776230-4 776231-4 1-776180-4 1-776163-4 1-776230-4 1-776231-4 776180-5 776163-5 776230-5 776231-5 1-776180-5 1-776163-5 1-776230-5 1-776231-5 1-776180-6 1-776163-6 - 1-776231-6 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS AMPSEAL Connectors WIRE SEALING RANGE The wire sealing range is the recommended outside diameter of the wire insulation required to maintain an environmental seal in the rear connector cavities. Contact Size Standard Seal 1.3 mm 16-20 AWG (1.5-0.5mm2) .067-.106 (1.7-2.7) Accessories Wire relief is available as an accessory for the AMPSEAL 23 and 35 positions connectors. The wire relief offers a high level of protection and helps reduce strain from the wires. WIRE RELIEF Positions Part Number Description 23 776464-1 (one half, two halves required per receptacle housing) Vertical, sealed receptacle housing wire relief (accepts no. 4 self-tapping screw) 35 776463-1 (one half, two halves required per receptacle housing) Vertical, sealed receptacle housing wire relief (accepts no. 4 self-tapping screw) Contacts The AMPSEAL connectors commonly use the 1.3 mm three contact beam lanceless stamped & formed contact system. 1.3 MM CONTACT PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Durability TE Spec 109-27. Mate and unmate specimens for 10 cycles at maximum rate of 600 cycles per hour. See note. Contact Retention TE Spec 109-30. Apply an axial load of 115 N to contacts in the axial direction with wedge lock in locked position. Contacts shall not dislodge. Current Rating Up to 17 amps gold, up to 8 amps tin, consult TE product document 108-1329. Crimp Tensile Strength Contact Size Tensile Strength Size 20 80 lbs Size 18 90 lbs Size 16 150 lbs Note: Shall meet visual requirements, show no physical damage and shall meet requirements of additional tests as specified in Test Sequence in Figure 3 of TE product document 108-1329. PAGE 15 AMPSEAL Connectors 1.3 MM STAMPED & FORMED CONTACTS FOR AMPSEAL Receptacle Part Numbers Size 1.3 mm Strip Form Package Quantity Loose Piece Package Quantity 770520-1 5000 770854-1 1000 770520-3 5000 770854-3 1000 Wire Size AWG (mm2) Insulation Diameter (mm) 16-20 (1.5-0.5) .067-.106 (1.7-2.7) Finish Pre-tin plated Selective gold plated SEALING PLUGS Open cavities provide pathways for contaminates to enter the connectors. To maintain seal integrity, any unused cavity that has been pierced must be filled with the appropriate size sealing plug. Color Part Number Contact Size Wire Gauge Range Material White 770678-1 1.3 mm 16-20 AWG Nylon INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS AMPSEAL Connectors Tooling Tools are specific to the contact style. To create a proper crimp and achieve the highest performance specifications, contacts must be crimped with the recommended tooling. HAND TOOLS FOR 1.3 MM CONTACTS PRO-CRIMPER III Receptacle Strip Form 770520-1 770520-3 CERTI-CRIMP II Receptacle Loose Piece 770854-1 770854-3 Tool P/N Description 58529-1 PRO-CRIMPER III hand tool and die set assembly 2217748-1 CERTI-CRIMP II straight action hand tool Note: Base PRO-CRIMPER III tool part number with -2 suffix is the part number for the die set, which can be ordered separately AUTOMATED TOOLING FOR 1.3 MM CONTACTS Receptacle Strip Form 770520-1 770520-3 Applicator P/N Description 2151376-1 OCEAN end feed applicator with mechanical feed 2151376-2 OCEAN end feed applicator with pneumatic feed Note: Applicators with additional feed styles are available, contact your representative PAGE 17 AMPSEAL Connectors How To Instructions CONTACT INSERTION Step 1: Grasp crimped contact approximately one inch behind the contact barrel. Step 2: Check that the wedgelock of the plug assembly is in open position. Align the contact with the applicable cavity. Step 3: Insert the contact into the connector cavity until there is an audible and tactile click. A slight tug will verify the contact is locked in place. Note AMPSEAL connector grommet is solid until pierced. Step 4: After all the contacts have been inserted, close the wedgelock by simultaneously squeezing locking latches inward and pushing the wedgelock into the housing. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS AMPSEAL Connectors CONTACT REMOVAL Step 1: Insert the tip of a screwdriver (2-5mm wide blade) between the edge of the plug assembly housing and one corner of the wedgelock. Step 2: Gently pry the edge of the wedgelock until it is released from (but not completely removed) the housing. Repeat these steps for the opposite corner of the wedge. Step 3: Gently pull the wire of the contact to be removed while rotating the wire (a quarter turn each direction) back and forth until the contact is removed from the housing. PAGE 19 AMPSEAL Connectors NOTES: INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Contents AMPSEAL 16 Connector Overview......................22 Product Documentation..........................................22 Performance Specifications...................................22 Material Specifications.............................................23 Dimensions...................................................................23 Configurations.............................................................23 Ordering Information............................................... 24 Accessories............................................................25-26 AMPSEAL 16 Hybrid Lever.............................. 27-28 Contacts................................................................ 29-30 Tooling...................................................................... 31-32 How To Instructions...........................................33-34 AMPSEAL 16 Connectors AMPSEAL 16 Connector Overview The AMPSEAL 16 connector system is targeted for off-road, heavy duty industrial, recreational and agricultural applications. This wire-to-wire and wire-to-device connector line was designed to meet the rigorous demands of an industry that requires the highest standards in performance. AMPSEAL 16 receptacle and pin housings offer a one-piece approach and come fully assembled. APPLICABLE PRODUCT DOCUMENTATION Additional documentation is available for assistance with AMPSEAL 16 products. The following TE Connectivity document numbers may be helpful: 1654281-2 (Catalog Section) 108-2184 (Product Specification) 114-13065 (Application Specification) 114-13045 (Application Specification, Contacts) 408-8623 (Instruction Sheet) 501-708 (Qualification Test Report) AMPSEAL 16 CONNECTOR PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Current: Up to 13 amps Temperature: Operating at temperatures -40°C to +125°C Durability: See note. 50 cycles. Insulation Resistance: 20 megohms minimum. SAE J2030 6.3. Insulation resistance at 1000 volts DC adjacent terminals measured after 60 seconds or until stabilization occurs. Immersion: IP67 rating Random Vibration: No discontinuities. See note. EIA-364-28 Subject mated specimens to 21 G’s rms between 25 to 2000 Hz. Twenty hours in each of three mutually perpendicular planes. Voltage: 250 volts DC Note: Shall meet visual requirements, show no physical damage, and meet requirements of additional tests as specified in Product Qualification and Requalification Test Sequence in Figure 3 of TE product document 108-2184. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS AMPSEAL 16 Connectors MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS Wire Seal: Silicone rubber Plug Peripheral Seal: Silicone rubber Housing 15% Glass filled thermoplastic CPA: 15% Glass filled thermoplastic PLR: 15% Glass filled thermoplastic DIMENSIONS B E C A F AMPSEAL 16 Receptacle Housing Cavity Overall Length A D AMPSEAL 16 Cap Overall Height B Overall Width C Overall Length D Overall Height E Overall Width F 2 1.45 (36.75) .93 (23.5) .80 (20.33) 1.87 (47.55) .75 (18.93) .77 (19.60) 3 1.45 (36.80) .93 (23.5) .98 (24.83) 1.87 (47.55) .75 (19.15) .95 (24.10) 4 1.44 (36.70) 1.06 (26.8) 1.00 (25.33) 1.87 (47.55) .88 (22.45) .97 (24.60) 6 1.44 (36.60) 1.22 (31.0) 1.00 (25.33) 1.87 (47.55) 1.05 (26.65) .97 (24.60) 8 1.45 (36.80) 1.24 (31.5) 1.15 (29.33) 1.87 (47.55) 1.05 (26.65) 1.13 (28.60) 12 1.45 (36.80) 1.24 (31.5) 1.51 (38.33) 1.87 (47.55) 1.05 (26.65) 1.48 (37.60) Dimensions are for reference only. CONFIGURATIONS 2 Positions 2 size 16 3 Positions 3 size 16 4 Positions 4 size 16 6 Positions 6 size 16 8 Positions 8 size 16 12 Positions 12 size 16 PAGE 23 AMPSEAL 16 Connectors ORDERING INFORMATION Position 2 3 4 6 8 12 Receptacle Receptacle Housing Cap Housing Cap Standard Dia. Seal Standard Dia. Seal Reduced Dia. Seal Reduced Dia. Seal PLR Color Keying Red Key A 776427-1 776428-1 776522-1 776534-1 Gray Key B 776427-2 776428-2 776522-2 776534-2 Yellow Key C 776427-3 776428-3 776522-3 776534-3 Green Key D 776427-4 776428-4 776522-4 776534-4 Red Key A 776429-1 776430-1 776523-1 776535-1 Gray Key B 776429-2 776430-2 776523-2 776535-2 Yellow Key C 776429-3 776430-3 776523-3 776535-3 Green Key D 776429-4 776430-4 776523-4 776535-4 Red Key A 776487-1 776488-1 776524-1 776536-1 Gray Key B 776487-2 776488-2 776524-2 776536-2 Yellow Key C 776487-3 776488-3 776524-3 776536-3 Green Key D 776487-4 776488-4 776524-4 776536-4 Red Key A 776433-1 776434-1 776531-1 776537-1 Gray Key B 776433-2 776434-2 776531-2 776537-2 Yellow Key C 776433-3 776434-3 776531-3 776537-3 Red Key A 776494-1 776495-1 776532-1 776538-1 Gray Key B 776494-2 776495-2 776532-2 776538-2 Yellow Key C 776494-3 776495-3 776532-3 776538-3 Green Key D 776494-4 776495-4 776532-4 776538-4 Red Key A 776437-1 776438-1 776533-1 776539-1 Gray Key B 776437-2 776438-2 776533-2 776539-2 Yellow Key C 776437-3 776438-3 776533-3 776539-3 Green Key D 776437-4 776438-4 776533-4 776539-4 Receptacle housing and cap PLR colors are mechanically keyed to mate only with identical colors. Part Number Suffix: -1 = A key (red PLR) -2 = B key (gray PLR) -3 = C key (yellow PLR) -4 = D key (green PLR) Cap CPA (Connector Position Assurance) Receptacle Housing INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS PLR (Primary Latch Reinforcement) AMPSEAL 16 Connectors WIRE SEALING RANGE The wire sealing range is the recommended outside diameter of the wire insulation required to maintain an environmental seal in the rear connector cavities. Contact Size Standard Seal Reduced Diameter Seal HDSF 16 14-20 AWG (2.0-0.5mm2) .086-.144 (2.18-3.67) .051-.100 (1.30-2.54) Accessories Backshells and mounting clips are accessory items available for use with AMPSEAL 16 connectors. These accessories cover design requirements by assisting with mounting, providing additional protection, and offering increased aesthetics. BACKSHELLS Part Numbers Number of Positions 2 3 4 6 8 12 † Conduit Size Standard Straight Standard 90° Low Profile 90° Rec. Housing Low Profile 90° Pin Housing NC08/NW7.5 2035047-1† 2035048-1† 2035366-1 2098436-1 2035048-5 † NC12/NW10 - NC08/NW7.5 2035047-2 2035366-3 2098436-3 † NC12/NW10 - NC08/NW7.5 2035047-3 NC12/NW10 2035047-5 NC16/NW13 - NC08/NW7.5 2035047-4 NC12/NW10 2035048-2 † 2035366-2 2098436-2 † 2035366-4 2098436-4 † 2035048-3 2035366-7 2098436-7 † 2035048-7 2035366-9 2098436-9 2035048-6 † † - 1-2035366-1 1-2098436-1 † - 2035366-8 2098436-8 † 2035047-6 - 1-2035366-0 1-2098436-0 NC16/NW13 - - 1-2035366-2 1-2098436-2 NC12/NW10 2035047-7 - - NC16/NW13 2035047-9 2035047-9 - - NC12/NW10 2035047-8 - - - NC16/NW13 1-2035047-0 - - - NC20/NW17 1-2035047-1 - - - - † † † † † † = Backshell available only with latch window. Can be used for cap assembly if desired. PAGE 25 AMPSEAL 16 Connectors BACKSHELLS - NEXT GENERATION Plug Part Numbers Number of Positions 2 3 4 6 8 12 Cap Part Numbers Conduit Size Straight Backshell Part Number 90° Adapter Part Number Straight Backshell Part Number 90° Adapter Part Number Smooth 2292797-1 2292849-1 2292860-1 2292849-1 NC12/NW10 2292797-2 2292849-2 2292860-2 2292849-2 NC08/NW7.5 2292797-3 2292849-3 2292860-3 2292849-3 Smooth 2292798-1 2292849-1 2292861-1 2292849-1 NC12/NW10 2292798-2 2292849-2 2292861-2 2292849-2 NC08/NW7.5 2292798-3 2292849-3 2292861-3 2292849-3 Smooth 2292799-1 2292850-1 2292862-1 2292850-1 NC16/NW13 2292799-2 2292850-2 2292862-2 2292850-2 NC12/NW10 2292799-3 2292850-3 2292862-3 2292850-3 Smooth 2292800-1 2292850-1 2292863-1 2292850-1 NC16/NW13 2292800-2 2292850-2 2292863-2 2292850-2 NC12/NW10 2292800-3 2292850-3 2292863-3 2292850-3 Smooth 2292801-1 2292851-1 2292864-1 2292851-1 NC20/NW17 2292801-2 2292851-2 2292864-2 2292851-2 NC16/NW13 2292801-3 2292851-3 2292864-3 2292851-3 Smooth 2292802-1 2292851-1 2292865-1 2292851-1 NC16/NW13 2292802-2 2292851-2 2292865-2 2292851-2 NC12/NW10 2292802-3 2292851-3 2292865-3 2292851-3 Note: Expected availability December 2015, contact your representative MOUNTING CLIPS Part Number Description 1924487-1 Mounting clip without anti-rotational feature 1924487-2 Mounting clip with anti-rotational feature INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS AMPSEAL 16 Connectors AMPSEAL 16 Hybrid Lever Overview The AMPSEAL 16 hybrid lever is a sealed connector system that features a lever slide mechanism for mating and a slide in mounting clip. The mix of 24 size 16 and 4 size 12 terminals creates design flexibility for use in various vehicle applications. The tool-less mounting design, environmental protection, and temporary panel retention latches (which temporarily hold the connector in place for one person mounting through the panel) all reduce application cost and assembly time. APPLICABLE PRODUCT DOCUMENTATION Additional documentation is available for assistance with the AMPSEAL 16 hybrid lever product. The following TE Connectivity document numbers may be helpful: 108-32036 (Product Specification) 114-32117 (Application Specification) 501-32026 (Qualification Test Report) DIMENSIONS B E C F A D AMPSEAL 16 Hybrid Lever Receptacle Housing Cavity Overall Length A 28 2.08 (52.95) AMPSEAL 16 Hybrid Lever Cap Overall Height B Overall Width C Overall Length D Overall Height E Overall Width F 1.82 (46.25) 4.59 (116.5) 2.86 (72.75) 1.91 (48.45) 4.38 (111.25) Dimensions are for reference only. CONFIGURATION 28 Positions 24 size 16, 4 size 12 PAGE 27 AMPSEAL 16 Connectors ORDERING INFORMATION Position 28 Keying Plug Housing Cap Housing Key A 2138839-1 2138846-1 Key B 2138839-2 2138846-2 Accessories Wire covers and mounting clips are accessory items available for use with AMPSEAL 16 hybrid lever connectors. These accessories cover design requirements by assisting with mounting and providing wire strain relief. WIRE COVER Part Number 2138853-1 Description Wire cover for 28 position AMPSEAL 16 hybrid lever MOUNTING CLIPS Part Number Description 2138852-1 Mounting clip, 5 mm panel 2138852-2 Mounting clip, 4 mm panel 2138852-3 Mounting clip, 3 mm panel INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS AMPSEAL 16 Connectors Contacts AMPSEAL 16 and AMPSEAL 16 hybrid lever connectors commonly use the HDSF size 16 contact system. The contacts are round, stamped & formed contacts with dual beam sockets. HDSF 16 CONTACT PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Durability SAE J2030 6.11. 50 cycles. See note. Current Rating Up to 13 amps, consult TE product document 108-2184. Contact Retention IEC 512-8, Test 51a. Apply axial load of 111 N to contacts at a maximum rate of 10 N per second (or 50mm per minute) and hold for 10 seconds. Contacts shall not dislodge. Crimp Tensile Strength USCAR 21 @ 50mm/min Wire Gauge Tensile Strength 18 AWG 90 N Min 16 AWG 120 N Min 14 AWG 180 N Min Voltage Drop Contact Size Test Current Amps Voltage Drop (millivolts max) 18 8 100 16 10 100 14 13 100 Note: Shall meet visual requirements, show no physical damage, and meet requirements of additional tests as specified in the Product Qualification and Requalification Test Sequence in Figure 3 of TE product document 108-2184. USCAR is a trademark. PAGE 29 AMPSEAL 16 Connectors HDSF 16 STAMPED & FORMED CONTACTS FOR AMPSEAL 16 CONNECTORS Pin Part Numbers Size HDSF 16 Strip Form Package Quantity Loose Piece Package Quantity 1924463-1 4000 1924579-1 1000 1924463-3 4000 1924579-3 1000 776349-1 4000 - - 776349-3 4000 - - 638078-1 4000 776300-1 1000 638078-3 4000 776300-2 1000 638112-1 4000 776298-1 1000 638112-3 4000 776298-2 1000 2098250-1 4000 - - 2098250-3 4000 - - 2098252-1 4000 - - 2098252-3 4000 - - Receptacle Part Numbers Size HDSF 16 Strip Form Package Quantity Loose Piece Package Quantity 1924464-1 4000 1924580-1 1000 1924464-2 4000 1924580-2 1000 776493-1 4000 - - 776493-2 4000 - - 776492-1 4000 776299-1 1000 776492-2 4000 776299-2 1000 776491-1 4000 776297-1 1000 776491-2 4000 776297-2 1000 2098251-1 4000 - - 2098251-2 4000 - - 2098253-1 4000 - - 2098253-2 4000 - - Wire Size AWG (mm2) Insulation Diameter (mm) Wire Insulation Support 18-20 (0.8-0.5) .107-.05 (2.72-1.27) yes 18-20 (0.8-0.5) .131-.089 (3.33-2.26) yes 14-18 (2.0-0.8) .131-.089 (3.33-2.26) yes 14-18 (2.0-0.8) .155-0.077 (3.94-1.96) no 18 (1.5-0.8) .118-.065 (3.00-1.65) yes 14 (2.0-1.5) .128-.083 (3.25-2.10) yes Gold Nickel Gold Nickel Gold Nickel Gold Nickel Gold Nickel Gold Nickel Wire Size AWG (mm2) Insulation Diameter (mm) Wire Insulation Support 18-20 (0.8-0.5) .107-.05 (2.72-1.27) yes 18-20 (0.8-0.5) .131-.089 (3.33-2.26) yes 14-18 (2.0-0.8) .131-.089 (3.33-2.26) yes 14-18 (2.0-0.8) .155-.077 (3.94-1.96) no 18 (1.5-0.8) .118-.065 (3.00-1.65) yes 14 (2.0-1.5) .128-.083 (3.25-2.10) yes INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Finish Finish Gold Nickel Gold Nickel Gold Nickel Gold Nickel Gold Nickel Gold Nickel AMPSEAL 16 Connectors SEALING PLUGS Open cavities provide pathways for contaminates to enter the connectors. To maintain seal integrity, any unused cavity must be filled with the appropriate size sealing plug. Color Part Number Contact Size Wire Gauge Range Description Yellow 776363-1 Size 16 16-20 AWG PBT, used with AMPSEAL 16 (standard diameter cavities) White 776364-1 Size 20 16-20 AWG PBT, used with AMPSEAL 16 (reduced diameter cavities) Tooling Tools are specific to the contact style. To create a proper crimp and achieve the highest performance specifications, contacts must be crimped with the recommended tooling. HAND TOOLS FOR HDSF 16 CONTACTS PRO-CRIMPER III CERTI-CRIMP II Pin Loose Piece Socket Strip Form Socket Loose Piece Tool P/N Description 1924463-1 1924463-3 1924579-1 1924579-3 1924464-1 1924464-2 1924580-1 1924580-2 2119118-1 PRO-CRIMPER III hand tool and die set assembly 638078-1 638078-3 776349-1 776349-3 776300-1 776300-2 776492-1 776492-2 776493-1 776493-2 776299-1 776299-2 91337-1 PRO-CRIMPER III hand tool and die set assembly 638112-1 638112-3 776298-1 776298-2 776491-1 776491-2 776297-1 776297-2 2217753-1 CERTI-CRIMP II straight action hand tool Pin Strip Form Note: Base PRO-CRIMPER III tool part number with -2 suffix is the part number for the die set, which can be ordered separately PAGE 31 AMPSEAL 16 Connectors AUTOMATED TOOLING FOR HDSF 16 CONTACTS OCEAN end feed applicator OCEAN side feed applicator Pin Strip Form Socket Strip Form 1924463-1 1924463-3 1924464-1 1924464-2 638078-1 638078-3 776349-1 776349-3 776492-1 776492-2 776493-1 776493-2 638112-1 638112-3 776491-1 776491-2 2098250-1 2098250-3 2098252-1 2098252-3 2098251-1 2098251-2 2098253-1 2098253-2 Applicator P/N Description 2151962-1 OCEAN end feed applicator with mechanical feed 2151962-2 OCEAN end feed applicator with pneumatic feed 2151731-1 OCEAN end feed applicator with mechanical feed 2151731-2 OCEAN end feed applicator with pneumatic feed 2151239-1 OCEAN end feed applicator with mechanical feed 2151239-2 OCEAN end feed applicator with pneumatic feed 2151617-1 OCEAN end feed applicator with mechanical feed 2151617-2 OCEAN end feed applicator with pneumatic feed 1530207-1 OCEAN side feed applicator that crops the terminal strip, for use in lead-maker 1530207-2 OCEAN side feed applicator that crops the terminal strip, for use in bench press 1530207-6 OCEAN side feed applicator that does not crop the terminal strip, for use in lead-maker Note: Applicators with additional feed styles are available, contact your representative EXTRACTION TOOL FOR HDSF 16 CONTACTS Part Number 776106-1 Description Contact extraction tool for HDSF 16 contacts INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS AMPSEAL 16 Connectors How To Instructions CONTACT INSERTION Step 1: Grasp crimped contact approximately one inch behind the contact barrel. Step 2: Verify the PLR is in the pre-staged position, unlocked. Step 4: Push the contact straight into the connector cavity until the contact retention finger returns to its normal position behind the retention shoulder on the contact. A slight tug will verify the contact is locked in place. Step 5: When all of the required contacts have been inserted, push the PLR into the fully locked position. Step 3: Align the contact with the desired circuit cavity at the rear of the housing assembly. PAGE 33 AMPSEAL 16 Connectors CONTACT REMOVAL Step 1: Insert the removal tool into the PLR extraction slot and pull until the PLR is completely removed from the housing. Step 2: Insert the tool into the contact cavity and deflect the contact retention finger. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Step 3: Gently pull the wire until the contact is free from the housing. Contents Circular DIN Connector Overview...................... 36 Product Documentation......................................... 36 Performance Specifications.................................. 36 Material Specifications............................................ 36 Dimensions...................................................................37 Configurations.............................................................37 Ordering Information............................................... 38 Accessories............................................................38-39 Contacts..................................................................39-41 Tooling.................................................................... 42-44 Circular DIN Connectors Circular DIN Connector Overview The Circular DIN connectors are designed to meet the requirements of the DIN 72585/ISO 15170 standards. They feature a coupling ring for mating. Circular DIN connectors are suitable for in-line, flange mount, or PCB applications. APPLICABLE PRODUCT DOCUMENTATION Additional documentation is available for assistance with Circular DIN products. The following TE document numbers may be helpful: 1654286-3 (Catalog Section) 108-18621 (Product Specification) 114-18255 (Application Specification) CIRCULAR DIN CONNECTOR PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Current: Up to 40 amps Temperature: Operating at temperatures -40°C to +120°C for plastic parts, short term up to +140°C defined in the standard ISO 15170 Durability: 20 cycles, max. testing requirement in the standard ISO 15170, former DIN 72585 Insulation Resistance: No flash over or breakdown between every two contacts or between every contact and outer contour of the housing permitted at 1000 volts AC and 50 or 60 Hz for 60 seconds. Immersion: No ingress of water is allowed, acc. to DIN 40050-9 IPX7, IPX9K Vibration: According to standard ISO 15170, former DIN 72585 Dielectric Withstanding Voltage: No flash over or breakdown between every two contacts or between every contact and outer contour of the housing permitted at 1000 volts AC and 50 or 60 Hz for 60 seconds. MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS Flange Seal: Silicone rubber Housing: Glass filled PBT and PA INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Circular DIN Connectors DIMENSIONS A ØD ØB C Circular DIN Socket Housing Cavity Overall Length A Circular DIN Pin Housing Overall Height ØB Overall Length C Overall Height ØD 2 1.22 (31.0) 1.29 (32.8) 1.73 (44.0) 1.34 (34.0) 3 1.22 (31.0) 1.29 (32.8) 1.73 (44.0) 1.34 (34.0) 4 1.22 (31.0) 1.29 (32.8) 1.73 (44.0) 1.34 (34.0) Dimensions are for reference only. CONFIGURATIONS 2 Positions 2 size 2.5 mm 3 Positions 3 size 2.5 mm 4 Positions 4 size 2.5 mm PAGE 37 Circular DIN Connectors ORDERING INFORMATION Position Keying Type Housing Color Socket Housing Pin Housing PCB Header Vertical 1-967402-3 1394324-1 (tin) 1-967325-3 2 1 Black 2 Gray 3 Green 3-967325-3 - - 4 Blue 4-967325-3 - - 1 Black 1-968968-2 (secondary locking) 1-967402-2 1394324-4 2 Gray 2-967325-2 - - 3 Green 3-967325-2 - - 4 Blue 4-967325-2 - - 1-968968-3 (secondary locking) 2-967325-3 2-968968-3 2-967402-3 - 1-967325-2 3 1-967325-1 1 Black 4 1-968968-1 (secondary locking) 1241598-1 (no ventilation disk) 1-967402-1 1394324-2 (tin) 1394324-3 (gold) 1703780-1 (ferrite disk) 2 Gray 2-967325-1 2-967402-1 - 3 Green 3-967325-1 3-967402-1 - 4 Blue 4-967325-1 4-967402-1 - Accessories Covers, backshells, and mounting rings are accessory items available for use with Circular DIN connectors. These accessories cover design requirements by assisting with mounting, providing additional protection, and offering increased aesthetics. COVERS Description Color Front cover for socket housing 967325, suitable for IPX9K Front cover for pin housing 967402, with ring Front cover for pin housing 967402, without ring INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Part Number 185636-1 Black 1394277-1 1394277-2 Circular DIN Connectors BACKSHELLS Description Color Part Number Right-angle adapter with universal clamp Black 965576-1 Vertical adapter with universal clamp Black 965784-1 Right-angle adapter for NW 7.5 mm diameter corrugated tubing Black 185793-1 Right-angle adapter for NW 8.5 mm diameter corrugated tubing Black 965577-1 Right-angle adapter for NW 10 mm diameter corrugated tubing Black 965783-1 Vertical adapter for NW 7.5 mm diameter corrugated tubing Black 185792-1 Vertical adapter for NW 8.5 mm diameter corrugated tubing Black 965785-1 Vertical adapter for NW 10 mm diameter corrugated tubing Black 965786-1 Right-angle adapter 4 position for hose Black 1534789-1 Vertical adapter 4 position for hose Black 1534791-1 Vertical adapter 4 position for jacketed cable 5.2-6.5 mm Black 1418916-1 Vertical adapter 4 position for jacketed cable 6.0-9.5 mm Black 1418917-1 Right-angle adapter 4 position for jacketed cable 5.2-6.5 mm Black 1418918-1 Right-angle adapter 4 position for jacketed cable 6.0-9.5 mm Black 1418919-1 MOUNTING RING Description Mounting ring for pin housing Color Part Number Black 965687-1 Contacts The Circular DIN connectors commonly use the 2.5 mm round, two-piece stamped & formed contact system. 2.5 MM CONTACT PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Durability Maximum mating cycles 10 (tin) 50 (silver) 100 (gold) Current Rating Contact Size 2.5 mm Max. Current up to 40 amps Contact Retention(in housing) Contact Size Min. Load 2.5 mm > 90 N with secondary retention up to 100 N Crimp Tensile Strength Contact Size Tensile Strength .35 mm2 ≥ 50 N .5 mm2 ≥ 60 N 1.0 mm2 ≥ 100 N 1.5 mm2 ≥ 150 N 2.5 mm2 ≥ 200 N 4.0 mm2 ≥ 250 N PAGE 39 Circular DIN Connectors 2.5 MM STAMPED & FORMED CONTACTS FOR CIRCULAR DIN Stamped & Formed Pins Pin Part Numbers Size 2.5 mm Strip Form Package Quantity Loose Piece Package Quantity 929963-1 3500 962967-1 500 929963-8 3500 962967-8 500 1-929963-0 3500 1-962967-0 500 929964-1 3500 962968-1 500 1-929964-0 3500 1-962968-0 500 929965-1 2500 962969-1 Wire Size (mm2) Insulation Diameter FLR (mm) Finish Tin plated 0.5-1.0 1.4-2.1 ≥1.0-2.5 1.9-3.0 500 ≥2.5-4.0 2.7-3.6 Tin plated Wire Size (mm2) Insulation Diameter FLR (mm) Finish 0.2-0.4 1.2-2.1 Gold plated Tin plated Gold plated Stamped & Formed Pins with Single Wire Sealing System Pin Part Numbers Size 2.5 mm Strip Form Package Quantity Loose Piece Package Quantity 929966-1 3500 962970-1 500 929966-7 3500 962970-7 500 929967-1 3000 962971-1 500 929967-4 3000 962971-4 500 929967-7 3000 962971-7 500 1-929967-4 3000 1-962971-4 500 929967-8 3000 962971-8 500 1-929967-0 3000 1-962971-0 500 929968-1 3000 962972-1 500 929968-4 3000 962972-4 500 929968-7 3000 962972-7 500 929968-8 3000 962972-8 500 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Tin plated Silver plated Tin plated 0.5-1.0 1.2-2.1 Silver plated Gold plated Tin plated ≥1.0-2.5 2.2-3.0 Silver plated Gold plated Circular DIN Connectors Stamped & Formed Sockets Socket Part Numbers Size 2.5 mm Loose Piece Package Quantity Wire Size (mm2) Insulation Diameter FLR (mm) Finish 3000 962976-1 500 0.2-0.4 1.15-1.6 Tin plated 929970-1 3000 962977-1 500 929970-7 3000 962977-7 500 929970-8 3000 962977-8 500 Gold plated 929971-1 3000 962978-1 500 Tin plated 929971-7 3000 962978-7 500 929971-8 3000 962978-8 500 929972-1 3000 962979-1 500 Strip Form Package Quantity 929969-1 Tin plated 0.5-1.0 ≥1.0-2.5 1.4-2.1 1.9-3.0 Silver plated Silver plated Gold plated ≥2.5-4.0 2.7-3.0 Tin plated Wire Size (mm2) Insulation Diameter FLR (mm) Finish 0.2-0.4 1.2-2.1 Tin plated Stamped & Formed Sockets with Single Wire Sealing System Socket Part Numbers Size 2.5 mm Strip Form Package Quantity Loose Piece Package Quantity 929973-1 3000 962980-1 500 929974-1 3000 962981-1 500 929974-4 3000 962981-4 500 929974-8 3000 962981-8 500 929974-7 3000 962981-7 500 1-929974-4 3000 1-962981-4 500 929975-1 3000 962982-1 500 929975-4 3000 962982-4 500 929975-8 3000 962982-8 500 929975-7 3000 962982-7 500 Tin plated 0.5-1.0 1.2-2.1 Gold plated Silver plated Tin plated ≥1.0-2.5 2.2-3.0 Gold plated Silver plated PAGE 41 Circular DIN Connectors WIRE SEALS Wire seals are required for connectors without an integrated rear seal to maintain an environmental seal. Contact Size Insulation Diameter (mm) Color Part Number 1.2-2.1 FLR Gray 828920-1 2.2-3.0 FLR Violet 828921-1 2.5 mm Package Quantity 5000 SEALING PLUGS Open cavities provide pathways for contaminates to enter the connectors. To maintain seal integrity, any unused cavity must be filled with the appropriate size sealing plug. Contact Size 2.5 mm Wire Size up to 3.0 mm up to 3.7 mm Color Part Number Natural 828922-1 Green 828922-2 Natural 828986-1 Package Quantity 10,000 Tooling Tools are specific to the contact style. To create a proper crimp and achieve the highest performance specifications, contacts must be crimped with the recommended tooling. PRO-CRIMPER III CERTI-LOK HAND TOOL FOR 2.5 MM CONTACTS Pin Loose Piece Socket Strip Form Socket Loose Piece 1-929967-0 1-929967-4 929967-1 929967-4 929967-7 929967-8 1-926971-0 1-926971-4 962971-1 962971-4 962971-7 962971-8 1-929974-4 929974-1 929974-4 929974-7 929974-8 929975-1 929975-4 929975-7 929975-8 1-929964-0 929964-1 1-962968-0 962968-1 929971-1 929971-7 929971-7 Pin Strip Form Tool P/N Description 1-962981-4 962981-1 962981-4 962981-7 962981-8 962982-1 962982-4 962982-7 962982-8 58606-1 PRO-CRIMPER III hand tool and die set assembly 962978-1 962978-7 962978-8 734285-2 CERTI-LOK hand tool with fixed die INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Circular DIN Connectors AUTOMATED TOOLING FOR 2.5 MM CONTACTS OCEAN end feed applicator Pin Strip Form 1-929963-0 929963-1 929963-8 OCEAN side feed applicator Socket Strip Form 929970-1 929970-7 929970-8 929966-1 929966-7 929973-1 1-929964-0 929964-1 929971-1 929971-7 929971-8 929965-1 929972-1 Applicator P/N Description 1426121-1 OCEAN side feed applicator that crops the terminal strip, for use in lead-maker 1426121-2 OCEAN side feed applicator that crops the terminal strip, for use in bench press 1426121-6 OCEAN side feed applicator that does not crop the terminal strip, for use in lead-maker 1528689-1 OCEAN side feed applicator with fine adjust that crops the terminal strip, for use in lead-maker 1528689-2 OCEAN side feed applicator with fine adjust that crops the terminal strip, for use in bench press 1528689-6 OCEAN side feed applicator that does not crop the terminal strip, for use in lead-maker 2151732-1 OCEAN end feed applicator with mechanical feed 2151732-2 OCEAN end feed applicator with pneumatic feed 2266503-1 OCEAN end feed applicator with mechanical feed 2266503-2 OCEAN end feed applicator with pneumatic feed 1426425-1 OCEAN side feed applicator that crops the terminal strip, for use in lead-maker 1426425-2 OCEAN side feed applicator that crops the terminal strip, for use in bench press 1426425-6 OCEAN side feed applicator that does not crop the terminal strip, for use in lead-maker Note: Applicators with additional feed styles are available, contact your representative PAGE 43 Circular DIN Connectors AUTOMATED TOOLING FOR 2.5 MM CONTACTS (CONTINUED) Pin Strip Form 1-929967-0 1-929967-4 929967-1 929967-4 929967-7 929967-8 - Socket Strip Form Applicator P/N Description 1-929974-4 929974-1 929974-4 929974-7 929974-8 2151139-1 OCEAN end feed applicator with mechanical feed 2151139-1 OCEAN end feed applicator with pneumatic feed 929975-1 929975-4 929975-7 929975-8 2151345-1 OCEAN end feed applicator with mechanical feed 2151345-2 OCEAN end feed applicator with pneumatic feed Note: Applicators with additional feed styles are available, contact your representative EXTRACTION TOOL FOR 2.5 MM CONTACTS Part Number Description 1-1579007-8 Contact extraction tool for 2.5 mm contact system INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Contents HDSCS Connector Overview................................ 46 Product Documentation......................................... 46 Performance Specifications.................................. 46 Material Specifications.............................................47 Dimensions...................................................................47 Configurations............................................................ 48 Ordering Information........................................ 49-50 Accessories............................................................. 51-52 Contacts.................................................................53-55 Tooling.....................................................................57-60 How To Instructions........................................... 60-61 HDSCS Connectors HDSCS Connector Overview The Heavy Duty Sealed Connector Series (HDSCS) offers several cavity arrangements and mixed wire sizes. The rugged, thermoplastic connectors have a secondary lock with poke-yoke feature and can be used for in-line or flange mount applications. HDSCS connectors are available in five housing sizes and four keying options. APPLICABLE PRODUCT DOCUMENTATION Additional documentation is available for assistance with HDSCS products. The following TE Connectivity document numbers may be helpful: 1654326-1 (Catalog Section) 108-94020 (Product Specification) 114-18756 (Application Specification) 1563709 (Product Group Drawing) HDSCS CONNECTOR PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Current: Up to 40 amps Temperature: Operating at temperatures -40°C to +140°C Durability: Up to 10 cycles (tin), up to 50 cycles (silver), up to 100 cycles (gold), see individual product specifications for additional details. Insulation Resistance: 500 volts DC, test acc. to ISO 16750-2 (4.12). Immersion: IP67 rating, IP6K9K with cover, for tab housings with flange, only by observing mounting instructions. Random Vibration: No physical damage of housings and contacts, no derogation of function; the connection may not open at 177 m/s2, 94 hours for each of the three axes. See product specification 108-94020 for full specifications. Voltage: Up to 42 volts DC Dielectric Withstanding Voltage: No flash over or breakdown between adjacent contacts and outer contour of the housing permitted at 500 volts AC and 50 or 60 Hz for 60 seconds. Flammability Product with UL 94 V0 rated material is available INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS HDSCS Connectors MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS Flange Seal: Silicone rubber Seal for Secondary Locking: Silicone rubber Housing: Glass filled PBT Secondary Locking: Glass filled PBT Slide Lock: Glass filled PBT DIMENSIONS E B C F A D HDSCS Receptacle Housing HDSCS Tab Housing Overall Length A Overall Height B Overall Width C Overall Length D Overall Height E Overall Width F A 1.23 (31.3) 0.73 (18.5) 1.02 (26.0) 1.64 (47.1) 0.75 (19.0) 1.09 (27.6) B 1.23 (31.3) 1.01 (25.7) 1.19 (30.2) 1.64 (47.1) 1.06 (27.0) 1.09 (27.6) C 1.23 (31.3) 1.01 (25.7) 1.23 (31.2) 1.64 (47.1) 1.06 (27.0) 1.28 (32.6) D 1.23 (31.3) 1.01 (25.7) 1.54 (39.2) 1.64 (47.1) 1.06 (27.0) 1.60 (40.6) E 1.23 (31.3) 1.01 (25.7) 2.02 (51.2) 1.64 (47.1) 1.06 (27.0) 2.07 (52.6) Group Dimensions are for reference only. PAGE 47 HDSCS Connectors GROUP A SIZE CONFIGURATIONS 2 Positions 2 size 1.5K GROUP B SIZE CONFIGURATIONS 2 Positions 2 size 2.8 3 Positions 3 size 1.5K 4 Positions 4 size 2.8 6 Positions 6 size 1.5K GROUP C SIZE CONFIGURATIONS 2 Positions 2 size 6.3 6 Positions 6 size 2.8 7 Positions 4 size 1.5K 3 size 2.8 8 Positions 8 size 1.5K GROUP D SIZE CONFIGURATIONS 12 Positions 12 size 1.5K 8 Positions 8 size 2.8 10 Positions 6 size 1.5K 4 size 2.8 GROUP E SIZE CONFIGURATIONS 12 Positions 12 size 2.8 15 Positions 9 size 1.5K 6 size 2.8 16 Positions 12 size 1.5K 4 size 2.8 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS 18 Positions 18 size 1.5K 4 Positions 4 size 6.3 HDSCS Connectors ORDERING INFORMATION Position 2 (3) 2 2 3 Group A A C A B Contact Size 2.8 1.5K 6.3 1.5K 2.8 4 E B 6.3 1.5K 6 C 7 C 2.8 (4) 1.5K (3) 2.8 Tab Housing Keying Color Receptacle Housing Flange Without Flange Black 1-1418483-1 1-1703841-1 1-1703839-1 Gray 2-1418483-1 2-1703841-1 2-1703839-1 Green 3-1418483-1 3-1703841-1 3-1703839-1 Blue 4-1418483-1 4-1703841-1 4-1703839-1 Black 1-1418448-2 - - Gray 2-1418448-2 - - Green 3-1418448-2 - - Blue 4-1418448-2 - - Black 1-1564542-1 1-1564546-1 1-1564544-1 Gray 2-1564542-1 2-1564546-1 2-1564544-1 Green 3-1564542-1 3-1564546-1 3-1564544-1 Blue 4-1564542-1 4-1564546-1 4-1564544-1 Black 1-1418448-1 1-1703843-1 1-1670730-1 Gray 2-1418448-1 2-1703843-1 2-1670730-1 Green 3-1418448-1 3-1703843-1 3-1670730-1 Blue 4-1418448-1 4-1703843-1 4-1670730-1 Black 1-1418390-1 1-1703808-1 1-1703818-1 Gray 2-1418390-1 2-1703808-1 2-1703818-1 Green 3-1418390-1 3-1703808-1 3-1703818-1 Blue 4-1418390-1 4-1703808-1 4-1703818-1 Black 1-1564330-1 - 1-1564534-1 Gray 2-1564330-1 - 2-1564534-1 Green 3-1564330-1 - 3-1564534-1 Blue 4-1564330-1 - 4-1564534-1 Black 1-1418469-1 1-1703820-1 1-1703773-1 Gray 2-1418469-1 2-1703820-1 2-1703773-1 Green 3-1418469-1 3-1703820-1 3-1703773-1 Blue 4-1418469-1 4-1703820-1 4-1703773-1 Black 1-1418437-1 - - Gray 2-1418437-1 - - Green 3-1418437-1 - - Blue 4-1418437-1 - - Black 1-1418480-1 1-1670214-1 1-1703648-1 Gray 2-1418480-1 2-1670214-1 2-1703648-1 Green 3-1418480-1 3-1670214-1 3-1703648-1 Blue 4-1418480-1 4-1670214-1 4-1703648-1 PAGE 49 HDSCS Connectors ORDERING INFORMATION (CONTINUED) Position Group C Contact Size 1.5K 8 D 10 D D 2.8 (6) 1.5K (4) 2.8 1.5K 12 E 15 16 18 E E E 2.8 (9) 1.5K (6) 2.8 (12) 1.5K (4) 2.8 1.5K Tab Housing Keying Color Receptacle Housing Flange Without Flange Black 1-1418479-1 1-1564416-1 1-1564512-1 Gray 2-1418479-1 2-1564416-1 2-1564512-1 Green 3-1418479-1 3-1564416-1 3-1564512-1 Blue 4-1418479-1 4-1564416-1 4-1564512-1 Black 1-1670894-1 - 1-1564522-1 Gray 2-1670894-1 - 2-1564522-1 Green 3-1670894-1 - 3-1564522-1 Blue 4-1670894-1 - 4-1564522-1 Black 1-1564514-1 1-1564518-1 1-1564516-1 Gray 2-1564514-1 2-1564518-1 2-1564516-1 Green 3-1564514-1 3-1564518-1 3-1564516-1 Blue 4-1564514-1 4-1564518-1 4-1564516-1 Black 1-1703639-1 1-1564520-1 1-1564414-1 Gray 2-1703639-1 2-1564520-1 2-1564414-1 Green 3-1703639-1 3-1564520-1 3-1564414-1 Blue 4-1703639-1 4-1564520-1 4-1564414-1 Black 1-1670901-1 - - Gray 2-1670901-1 - - Green 3-1670901-1 - - Blue 4-1670901-1 - - Black 1-1563878-1 1-1564532-1 1-1564530-1 Gray 2-1563878-1 2-1564532-1 2-1564530-1 Green 3-1563878-1 3-1564532-1 3-1564530-1 Blue 4-1563878-1 4-1564532-1 4-1564530-1 Black 1-1564337-1 1-1564407-1 1-1564528-1 Gray 2-1564337-1 2-1564407-1 2-1564528-1 Green 3-1564337-1 3-1564407-1 3-1564528-1 Blue 4-1564337-1 4-1564407-1 4-1564528-1 Black 1-1563759-1 1-1564526-1 1-1564412-1 Gray 2-1563759-1 2-1564526-1 2-1564412-1 Green 3-1563759-1 3-1564526-1 3-1564412-1 Blue 4-1563759-1 4-1564526-1 4-1564412-1 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS HDSCS Connectors Accessories Several accessory items are available to complement the HDSCS connectors including backshells, fixing slides, and protection caps. Accessory items cover a wide array of design requirements such as assisting with mounting, providing additional protection, and offering enhanced aesthetics. BACKSHELLS Group A B C D E Part Number Description 1670365-1 Vertical adapter for NW 8.5 mm diameter corrugated tubing 1670150-1 Right-angle adapter for NW 8.5 mm diameter corrugated tubing 965576-1 Right-angle adapter with universal clamp 965784-1 Vertical adapter with universal clamp 185793-1 Right-angle adapter for NW 7.5 mm diameter corrugated tubing 965577-1 Right-angle adapter for NW 8.5 mm diameter corrugated tubing 965783-1 Right-angle adapter for NW 10 mm diameter corrugated tubing 185792-1 Vertical adapter for NW 7.5 mm diameter corrugated tubing 965785-1 Vertical adapter for NW 8.5 mm diameter corrugated tubing 965786-1 Vertical adapter for NW 10 mm diameter corrugated tubing 1534789-1 Right-angle adapter 4/7 position for hose 1534791-1 Vertical adapter 4/7 position for hose 1418916-1 Vertical adapter 4/7 position for jacketed cable 5.2-6.5 mm 1418917-1 Vertical adapter 4/7 position for jacketed cable 6.0-9.5 mm 1418918-1 Right-angle adapter 4/7 position for jacketed cable 5.2-6.5 mm 1418919-1 Right-angle adapter 4/7 position for jacketed cable 6.0-9.5 mm 1670364-1 Vertical adapter for NW 13 mm diameter corrugated tubing 1670057-1 Right-angle adapter for NW 13 mm diameter corrugated tubing 1563111-1 Vertical adapter for NW 13 mm diameter corrugated tubing 1563110-1 Right-angle adapter for NW 13 mm diameter corrugated tubing 1670866-1 Vertical adapter for NW 17 mm diameter corrugated tubing and hose 1670865-1 Right-angle adapter for NW 17 mm diameter corrugated tubing and hose PAGE 51 HDSCS Connectors FIXING SLIDES Fixing slides are used to help secure HDSCS connectors while mounting them. The locking slides can accommodate panel thicknesses from 1.0-3.5 mm. Group A B C D E Part Number Color Panel Thickness 1703838-6 Gray 3.5 mm 1703838-1 Yellow 3.0 mm 1703838-2 Red 2.5 mm 1703810-6 Gray 3.5 mm 1703810-1 Yellow 3.0 mm 1703810-2 Red 2.5 mm 1670720-6 Gray 3.5 mm 1670720-1 Yellow 3.0 mm 1670720-2 Red 2.5 mm 1564562-1 Yellow 3.0 mm 1564562-2 Red 2.5 mm 1564562-5 Gray 1.5 mm 1564562-4 Natural 1.0 mm 1564411-6 Gray 3.5 mm 1564411-1 Yellow 3.0 mm 1564411-2 Red 2.5 mm 1564411-5 Gray 1.5 mm PROTECTION CAPS The HDSCS protection caps provide an environmental seal and are used to protect the connector interface when the two halves are not mated. Group A B C D E Part Number Housing 2112299-1 Receptacle 2112289-1 Tab 2112300-1 Receptacle 2112291-1 Tab 2112301-1 Receptacle 2112293-1 Tab 2112302-1 Receptacle 2112295-1 Tab 2112303-1 Receptacle 2112297-1 Tab INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS HDSCS Connectors Contacts The HDSCS connectors commonly use the AMP MCP stamped & formed contact system. AMP MCP CONTACT PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Durability 10 cycles (tin) 50 cycles (silver) 100 cycles (gold) Current Rating Contact Size Max. Current 1.5K up to 20 amps 2.8 up to 40 amps 6.3/4.8K up to 40 amps Contact Retention Contact Size Min. Load 1.5K 40/60 N 2.8 80 N 6.3/4.8K 80 N Crimp Tensile Strength Contact Size Tensile Strength 1.5K .22 mm2 ≥ 32 N .35 mm2 ≥ 50 N .50 mm2 ≥ 60 N .75 mm2 ≥ 85 N 1.0 mm2 ≥ 108 N 1.25 mm2 ≥ 135 N (16 AWG) 1.5 mm2 ≥ 135 N 2.8 .22 mm2 ≥ 28 N .35 mm2 ≥ 50 N .50 mm2 ≥ 60 N .75 mm2 ≥ 85 N 1.0 mm2 ≥ 108 N 1.5 mm2 ≥ 150 N 2.5 mm2 ≥ 200 N 6.3./4.8K .35 mm2 ≥ 50 N .50 mm2 ≥ 60 N .75 mm2 ≥ 85 N 1.0 mm2 ≥ 108 N 1.5 mm2 ≥ 150 N 2.5 mm2 ≥ 200 N 4.0 mm2 ≥ 310 N 6.0 mm2 ≥ 450 N PAGE 53 HDSCS Connectors AMP MCP CONTACTS FOR HDSCS Stamped & Formed Tabs with Single Wire Sealing System - AMP MCP Tab Part Numbers Size 1.5K Loose Piece Package Quantity Wire Size (mm2) Insulation Dia. (mm) FLR Finish 4000 969029 500 0.2-0.5 1.2-1.6 -2/-3 964269 4000 964270 500 0.5-1.0 1.4-2.1 -2/-3/-5 1703278 4000 1703279 500 1.5 1.9-2.4 -2/-5 965982 3500 965983 500 0.2-0.5 max 2.1 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-3 max 2.1 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-2 1-xxx-3 2-xxx-1 2-xxx-2 2-xxx-3 Strip Form Package Quantity 969028 962915 3500 963748 500 0.5-1.0 2.8 962916 3300 963749 500 1.5-2.5 max 3.0 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-2 1-xxx-3 2-xxx-1 2-xxx-2 2-xxx-3 1719504 3200 1719503 500 12 TXL max 3.2 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-2 1.4-2.1 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-2 2-xxx-1 2-xxx-2 2.2-3.0 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-2 2-xxx-1 2-xxx-2 2.7-3.7 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-2 2-xxx-1 2-xxx-2 962917 6.3/ 4.8K 962918 962919 1500 1500 1500 963742 963743 963744 AMP MCP Tab Finish Codes Finish Code 500 500 500 Finish Code 0.5-1.0 1.5-2.5 >2.5-4.0 Material Material 1-xxx-2 CuSn, selective silver plated -2 CuFe2, pre-tin plated 1-xxx-3 CuSn, selective gold plated -3 CuSn4, gold plated 2-xxx-1 CuFe, pre-tin plated -5 CuSn4, selective silver plated 2-xxx-2 CuFe, selective silver plated 1-xxx-1 CuSn, pre-tin plated 2-xxx-3 CuFe, selective gold plated INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS HDSCS Connectors Stamped & Formed Receptacles with Single Wire Sealing System - AMP MCP Insulation Diameter (mm) Receptacle Part Numbers Size Strip Form Package Quantity Loose Piece Package Quantity Wire Size (mm2) FLK FLR Finish 1564324 4500 1564325 500 0.22-0.35 - 1.1-1.4 -1/-2/-3 1241380 4500 1241381 500 0.5-1.0 - 1.4-2.1 1418884 4500 1418885 500 >1.0-1.5 - 2.2-2.4 -1/-3 968882 4500 968896 500 0.35 - 1.2-1.4 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-3 968855 3500 968875 500 0.5-1.0 - 1.4-2.1 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-2 1-xxx-3 968857 4000 968876 500 >1.0-2.5 - 2.2-3.0 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-3 1241410 1500 1241411 500 0.35-0.5 1.3-2.3 1.2-1.6 -1/-3 1241412 1500 1241413 500 0.5-1.0 2.0-2.7 1.4-2.1 -1/-3 1241414 1500 1241415 500 >1.0-2.5 2.7-3.7 2.2-3.0 -1/-3 1241416 1500 1241417 500 >2.5-4.0 4.1-4.5 3.4-3.7 -1/-3 1241418 1500 1241419 500 4.0-6.0 - 3.4-4.3 -4 1-xxx-3 2-xxx-3 1.5K 2.8 6.3/ 4.8K -1/-2/-3 1-xxx-2* AMP MCP Receptacle Finish Codes Finish Code Material -1 CuNiSi, pre-tin plated -2 CuNiSi, selective gold plated -3 CuNiSi, selective silver plated -4 CuNiSi, tin-silver pre-plated 1-xxx-1 CuNiSi, pre-tin plated 1-xxx-2 CuNiSi, selective gold plated 1-xxx-2* CuNiSi, min 1.27 µm selective gold plated 1-xxx-3 CuNiSi, selective silver plated PAGE 55 HDSCS Connectors WIRE SEALS Wire seals are required for connectors without an integrated rear seal to maintain an environmental seal. Contact Size Insulation Diameter (mm) Color Part Number 0.9-1.2 Green 1718705-1 Red 964971-1 Blue 1394133-1 1.4-1.9 Gray 963530-1 1.9-2.1 Yellow 964972-1 1.9-2.4 Orange 2112323-1 1.2-2.1 Blue 2.2-3.0 White 828905-1 1.4-2.0 Yellow 2177018-1 2.0-2.7 White 1394511-1 2.7-2.9 Red brown 1823111-1 3.4-3.7 Blue 1394512-1 4.0-4.5 Green 1719043-1 1.2-1.6 1.5K 2.8 6.3/4.8K 828904-1 828904-2 Package Quantity 10,000 1000 10,000 10,000 SEALING PLUGS Open cavities provide pathways for contaminates to enter the connectors. To maintain seal integrity, any unused cavity must be filled with the appropriate size sealing plug. Contact Size Wire Size 1.5K 3.6 mm 2.8 5.6 mm 6.3/4.8K 8.5 mm Color Part Number White 963531-1 Natural 1394132-1 Natural 828922-1 Green 828922-2 Transparent 967652-1 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Package Quantity 10,000 HDSCS Connectors Tooling Tools are specific to the contact style. To create a proper crimp and achieve the highest performance specifications, contacts must be crimped with the recommended tooling. HAND TOOL FOR AMP MCP CONTACTS Contact Size 1.5K 2.8 6.3/ 4.8K Tab Strip Form Tab Loose Piece Receptacle Strip Form Receptacle Loose Piece Tool P/N 1703278 964269 969028 1703279 964270 969029 - - 539663-2 (die) 539663-2 (frame) - - 1418884 1418885 5-1579001-3 (die) 539635-1 (frame) - - 1564324 1564325 4-1579016-0 (die) 539635-1 (frame) 962915 962916 963748 963749 965982 965983 - - 968882 968896 539725-2 (die) 539635-1 (frame) 962917 962918 962919 963742 963743 963744 - - 539757-2 (die) 539635-1 (frame) - - 1241410 1241412 1241411 1241413 539955-2 (die) 539635-1 (frame) - - 1241416 1241414 1241415 1241417 539956-2 (die) 539635-1 (frame) - - 1241418 1241419 3-1579021-7 (die) 539635-1 (frame) - - 539758-2 (die) 539635-1 (frame) 539737-2 (die) 539635-1 (frame) Description ERGOCRIMP hand tool and die assembly ERGOCRIMP hand tool and die assembly ERGOCRIMP hand tool and die assembly PAGE 57 HDSCS Connectors AUTOMATED FOR AMP MCP CONTACTS OCEAN end feed applicator Contact Size Tab Strip Form Receptacle Strip Form 969028 - 964269 1.5K 1703278 - - - - 1418884 1564324 962915 - 962916 - 2.8 2.8 965982 - - 968882 2.8 Applicator P/N Feed Type 2151056-1 Mechanical end feed 2151056-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151935-1 Mechanical end feed 2151935-2 Pneumatic end feed 2266180-1 Mechanical end feed 2266180-2 Pneumatic end feed 2266179-1 Mechanical end feed 2266179-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151469-1 Mechanical end feed 2151469-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151181-1 Mechanical end feed 2151181-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151260-1 Mechanical end feed 2151260-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151840-1 Mechanical end feed 2151840-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151559-1 Mechanical end feed 2151559-2 Pneumatic end feed Note: Applicators with additional feed styles are available, contact your representative INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS HDSCS Connectors AUTOMATED FOR AMP MCP CONTACTS (CONTINUED) Contact Size Tab Strip Form Receptacle Strip Form 962917 - 962918 - 962919 - - 1241410 - 1241412 6.3/4.8K - 1241416 - 1241414 - 1241418 Applicator P/N Description 2266535-1 Mechanical end feed 2266535-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151783-1 Mechanical end feed 2151783-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151782-1 Mechanical end feed 2151782-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151695-1 Mechanical end feed 2151695-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151234-1 Mechanical end feed 2151234-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151151-1 Mechanical end feed 2151151-2 Pneumatic end feed 2266490-1 Mechanical end feed 2266490-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151466-1 Mechanical end feed 2151466-2 Pneumatic end feed Note: Applicators with additional feed styles are available, contact your representative PAGE 59 HDSCS Connectors EXTRACTION AND INSERTION TOOLS FOR AMP MCP CONTACTS Contact Size Part Number Description 539960-1 Extraction 1-1579007-1 Extraction 1579008-9 Insertion 519609-1 Insertion 2.8 6.3/4.8K 1-1579007-6 Extraction 6.3/4.8K 1-1579007-3 Extraction 1.5K 2.8 How To Instructions CONTACT INSERTION Step 1: Grasp crimped contact approximately one inch behind the contact barrel. Step 2: Make sure the contact is in the correct orientation. Verify the integrated secondary lock is in the unlocked position. Step 4: Push the integrated secondary lock into the locked position with a DT-RT1 or a screwdriver. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Step 3: Push contact straight into connector grommet until a click is felt. A slight tug will confirm that it is properly locked in place. HDSCS Connectors CONTACT REMOVAL Step 1: Using a DT-RT1 or a screwdriver, unlock the integrated secondary lock. Step 2: Using the appropriate extraction tool, insert the blades into the contact cavity until they stop. Step 3: Pull contact wire assembly out of connector. PAGE 61 HDSCS Connectors NOTES: INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Contents LEAVYSEAL Connector Overview................... 64 Product Documentation......................................... 64 Performance Specifications.................................. 64 Material Specifications............................................ 64 Dimensions.................................................................. 65 Configurations..................................................... 65-66 Ordering Information.........................................67-68 Accessories.............................................................69-71 Contacts.................................................................. 71-73 Tooling..................................................................... 75-77 How To Instructions..................................................78 LEAVYSEAL Connectors LEAVYSEAL Connector Overview The rugged LEAVYSEAL connectors are multi-pin and accept multiple wire sizes. LEAVYSEAL products utilize a lever lock system for mating and are available in several mounting styles and keying options. The housings come in six sizes and feature an integrated cable attachment. APPLICABLE PRODUCT DOCUMENTATION Additional documentation is available for assistance with LEAVYSEAL products. The following TE Connectivity document numbers may be helpful: 1307998-3 (Catalog Section) 108-18696 (Product Specification) 114-18376 (Application Specification) 2293396 (Product Group Drawing) LEAVYSEAL CONNECTOR PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Current: Up to 40 amps Temperature: Operating at temperatures ranges -40°C to +140°C, see individual product specifications for specific range. Durability: Up to 20 cycles (tin), up to 50 cycles (silver), up to 100 cycles (gold), see individual product specifications for additional details. Insulation Resistance: 500 volts DC, see individual product specifications for testing conditions. Immersion: IP67 rating, IP6K9K with cover Voltage: 42 volts AC/DC Dielectric Withstanding Voltage: No flash over or breakdown between adjacent contacts and outer contour of the housing permitted at 500 volts AC and 50 or 60 Hz for 60 seconds. Flammability Product with a UL 94 V0 rated material is available MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS Flange Seal: Silicone rubber Housing: Glass filled PBT Secondary Locking: Glass filled PBT INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS LEAVYSEAL Connectors DIMENSIONS E B C F A D LEAVYSEAL Receptacle Housing LEAVYSEAL Tab Housing Overall Length A Overall Height B Overall Width C Overall Length D Overall Height E Overall Width F 1 1.46 (37.0) 1.57 (40.0) 2.33 (57.9) 1.48 (37.6) 1.93 (49.0) 1.91 (48.4) 2 1.49 (37.9) 1.72 (43.7) 2.73 (69.4) 1.81 (46.1) 2.03 (51.5) 2.62 (66.6) 3 1.73 (44.0) 1.64 (41.7) 3.64 (92.5) 2.19 (55.5) 2.47 (62.7) 3.62 (92.0) 4 1.43 (36.4) 1.71 (43.5) 4.09 (104.0) - - - 5 1.73 (44.0) 1.81 (46.0) 4.04 (102.5) 1.80 (45.8) 2.78 (70.7) 4.46 (113.3) 6 1.83 (46.6) 1.79 (45.5) 5.26 (133.5) - - - Group Dimensions are for reference only. GROUP 1 CONFIGURATIONS 15 Positions 15 size 2.8 18 Positions 12 size 1.5K 6 size 2.8 GROUP 3 CONFIGURATIONS 26 Positions 12 size 1.5K 12 size 2.8 2 size 6.3 GROUP 2 CONFIGURATIONS 22 Positions 16 size 1.5K 6 size 2.8 21 Positions 21 size 2.8 29 Positions 26 size 1.5K 2 size 2.8 1 size 6.3 GROUP 4 CONFIGURATIONS 46 Positions 46 size 1.5K PAGE 65 LEAVYSEAL Connectors GROUP 5 CONFIGURATIONS 31 Positions 27 size 2.8 4 size 6.3 39 Positions 39 size 2.8 GROUP 6 CONFIGURATIONS 92 Positions 92 size 1.5K INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS 62 Positions 56 size 1.5K 6 size 2.8 LEAVYSEAL Connectors ORDERING INFORMATION Position 15 21 31 39 46 Group 1 2 5 5 4 Contact Size 2.8 2.8 (27) 2.8 (4) 6.3 2.8 1.5K Keying Housing Color A Black 1-1534126-1 1703799-1 - B Natural 2-1534126-1 - - C Blue 3-1534126-1 - - A Black 1-1534127-1 1-2112162-1 (flange) 1534238-1 (straight) B Natural 2-1534127-1 2-2112162-1 - C Blue 3-1534127-1 3-2112162-1 - D Violet 4-1534127-1 4-2112162-1 - A Bordeaux 1-1564297-6 - - 5 (56) 1.5K (6) 2.8 6 PCB 5-1418363-1 (straight) Emerald Green 5-1718321-3 5-1718323-1 F Fawn Brown 6-1718321-3 6-1718323-1 - A Black 1-2112231-1 - - Black 1-1418883-1 1-1718324-1 5-1418363-3 (90°) 1-1418362-1 (straight) 1-1418362-3 (90°) 2-1418362-1 (straight) B Gray 2-1418883-1 2-1718324-1 C Blue 3-1418883-1 3-1718324-1 - D Green 4-1418883-1 - - - 1-1452228-9 (straight) A 92 In-line/Flange E A 62 Tab Housing Receptacle Housing 1-703998-1 (NW 26 wire exit) Black 1.5K 3-1703998-1 (NW 29 wire exit) 2-1418362-3 (90°) B Black 4-1703998-1 (NW 29 wire exit) - - C Black 5-1703998-1 (NW 29 wire exit) - - PAGE 67 LEAVYSEAL Connectors ORDERING INFORMATION - V0 RATED MATERIAL Position Group Contact Size Keying Housing Color Receptacle Housing Tab Housing In-line/Flange PCB 18 1 (12) 1.5K (6) 2.8 A Black 1823440-2 1-1823448-2 - 21 2 2.8 A Black 1-2208688-1 1-2112162-1* (flange) 1534238-1* (straight) A Black 1-1823440-3 1-1823449-1 - B Gray 2-1823440-3 2-1823449-1 - C Blue 3-1823440-3 - - D Green 4-1823440-3 - - A Black 1-2112035-1 A Black 1-1823402-1 - - B Gray 2-1823402-1 - - C Blue 3-1823402-1 - - A Bordeaux 1-2208685-6 - - 22 26 29 31 39 62 1 (16) 1.5K (6) 2.8 3 (12) 1.5K (12) 2.8 (2) 6.3 2 (26) 1.5K (2) 2.8 (1) 6.3 5 5 5 (27) 2.8 (4) 6.3 2.8 (56) 1.5K (6) 2.8 1-2112041-1 1-2112041-2 - 5-1418363-1* (straight) E Emerald Green 5-2208684-3 5-1718323-1* F Fawn Brown 6-2208684-3 6-1718323-1* - A Black 1-1823498-1 - - B Gray 2-1823498-1 - - C Blue 3-1823498-1 - - D Green 4-1823498-1 - - *Non-V0 rated material INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS 5-1418362-3* (90°) LEAVYSEAL Connectors Accessories Backshells, adapters, locking slides, and protective covers are accessory items available for use with LEAVYSEAL connectors. These accessories cover design requirements by assisting with mounting, providing additional protection, and offering increased aesthetics. BACKSHELLS/COVERS To achieve an IP6K9K rating, backshells must be used with the LEAVYSEAL connectors. The 90° backshells are available with ribs to accommodate corrugated tubing. Positions Housing Part Number Tubing Receptacle 9-1394049-1 NW 13 Tab 9-1394049 NW 13 Receptacle 9-1394050-1 NW 17 Tab 2112167-1 NW 17 22 Receptacle 2112452-1 NW 17 26 Receptacle or Tab 2112046-1 NW 22 31 Receptacle 1418882-1 NW 26 1418882-1 NW 26 2112233-1 NW 22 1418882-1 NW 26 Receptacle/Tab 1823500-1 NW 26 Receptacle (NW 26 wire exit) 1703997-1 NW 26 Receptacle (NW 29 wire exit) 2141345-1 NW 29 15 21 39 46 62 62 (V0) 92 Receptacle Tab Receptacle Receptacle Tab PAGE 69 LEAVYSEAL Connectors ADAPTERS Adapters are available to aid in mounting LEAVYSEAL connectors. The adapters are available in multiple sizes and can mount up to four LEAVYSEAL connectors. Positions Housing Part Number Description Tab 1703806-1 1 bay, sealed 1718329-1 1 bay, unsealed 1813123-1 2 bays, unsealed 1813123-2 2 bays, 1 bay closed, unsealed 2138002-1 4 bays, sealed 15/22 39/62 Tab LOCKING SLIDES Locking slides are used to help secure LEAVYSEAL connectors while mounting them. The locking slides may be used with adapters or panels with a thickness of 2.5 mm, 3.0 mm, or 3.5 mm. Positions 15/22 21 26 39/62 Part Number Color Description 1703804-1 Red For use with adapter 2112166-1 Red For use with 2.5 mm panel thickness 2112166-2 Yellow For use with 3 mm panel thickness 2112166-3 Gray For use with 3.5 mm panel thickness 2112045-1 Red For use with 2.5 mm panel thickness 2112045-2 Yellow For use with 3 mm panel thickness 1718328-1 Red For use with adapter INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS LEAVYSEAL Connectors INTERFACE PROTECTION COVER The LEAVYSEAL protection cover provides an environmental seal and is used to protect the connector interface when the two halves are not mated. Positions 21 Part Number Color 1-1394052-1 Black Contacts The LEAVYSEAL connectors commonly use the AMP MCP stamped & formed contact system. AMP MCP CONTACT PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Durability 10 cycles (tin) 50 cycles (silver) 100 cycles (gold) Current Rating Contact Size Max. Current 1.5K up to 20 amps 2.8 up to 40 amps 6.3/4.8K up to 40 amps Contact Retention Contact Size Min. Load 1.5K 40/60 N 2.8 80 N 6.3/4.8K 80 N Crimp Tensile Strength Contact Size Tensile Strength 1.5K .22 mm2 ≥ 32 N .35 mm2 ≥ 50 N .50 mm2 ≥ 60 N .75 mm2 ≥ 85 N 1.0 mm2 ≥ 108 N 1.25 mm2 ≥ 135 N (16 AWG) 1.5 mm2 ≥ 135 N 2.8 .22 mm2 ≥ 28 N .35 mm2 ≥ 50 N .50 mm2 ≥ 60 N .75 mm2 ≥ 85 N 1.0 mm2 ≥ 108 N 1.5 mm2 ≥ 150 N 2.5 mm2 ≥ 200 N 6.3./4.8K .35 mm2 ≥ 50 N .50 mm2 ≥ 60 N .75 mm2 ≥ 85 N 1.0 mm2 ≥ 108 N 1.5 mm2 ≥ 150 N 2.5 mm2 ≥ 200 N 4.0 mm2 ≥ 310 N 6.0 mm2 ≥ 450 N PAGE 71 LEAVYSEAL Connectors AMP MCP CONTACTS FOR LEAVYSEAL Stamped & Formed Tabs with Single Wire Sealing System - AMP MCP Tab Part Numbers Size 1.5K Loose Piece Package Quantity Wire Size (mm2) Insulation Dia. (mm) FLR Finish 4000 969029 500 0.2-0.5 1.2-1.6 -2/-3 964269 4000 964270 500 0.5-1.0 1.4-2.1 -2/-3/-5 1703278 4000 1703279 500 1.5 1.9-2.4 -2/-5 965982 3500 965983 500 0.2-0.5 max 2.1 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-3 max 2.1 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-2 1-xxx-3 2-xxx-1 2-xxx-2 2-xxx-3 Strip Form Package Quantity 969028 962915 3500 963748 500 0.5-1.0 2.8 962916 3300 963749 500 1.5-2.5 max 3.0 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-2 1-xxx-3 2-xxx-1 2-xxx-2 2-xxx-3 1719504 3200 1719503 500 12 TXL max 3.2 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-2 1.4-2.1 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-2 2-xxx-1 2-xxx-2 2.2-3.0 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-2 2-xxx-1 2-xxx-2 2.7-3.7 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-2 2-xxx-1 2-xxx-2 962917 6.3/ 4.8K 962918 962919 1500 1500 1500 963742 963743 963744 AMP MCP Tab Finish Codes Finish Code 500 500 500 Finish Code 0.5-1.0 1.5-2.5 >2.5-4.0 Material Material 1-xxx-2 CuSn, selective silver plated -2 CuFe2, pre-tin plated 1-xxx-3 CuSn, selective gold plated -3 CuSn4, gold plated 2-xxx-1 CuFe, pre-tin plated -5 CuSn4, selective silver plated 2-xxx-2 CuFe, selective silver plated 1-xxx-1 CuSn, pre-tin plated 2-xxx-3 CuFe, selective gold plated INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS LEAVYSEAL Connectors Stamped & Formed Receptacles with Single Wire Sealing System - AMP MCP Insulation Diameter (mm) Receptacle Part Numbers Size Strip Form Package Quantity Loose Piece Package Quantity Wire Size (mm2) FLK FLR Finish 1564324 4500 1564325 500 0.22-0.35 - 1.1-1.4 -1/-2/-3 1241380 4500 1241381 500 0.5-1.0 - 1.4-2.1 1418884 4500 1418885 500 >1.0-1.5 - 2.2-2.4 -1/-3 968882 4500 968896 500 0.35 - 1.2-1.4 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-3 968855 3500 968875 500 0.5-1.0 - 1.4-2.1 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-2 1-xxx-3 968857 4000 968876 500 >1.0-2.5 - 2.2-3.0 1-xxx-1 1-xxx-3 1241410 1500 1241411 500 0.35-0.5 1.3-2.3 1.2-1.6 -1/-3 1241412 1500 1241413 500 0.5-1.0 2.0-2.7 1.4-2.1 -1/-3 1241414 1500 1241415 500 >1.0-2.5 2.7-3.7 2.2-3.0 -1/-3 1241416 1500 1241417 500 >2.5-4.0 4.1-4.5 3.4-3.7 -1/-3 1241418 1500 1241419 500 4.0-6.0 - 3.4-4.3 -4 1-xxx-3 2-xxx-3 1.5K 2.8 6.3/ 4.8K -1/-2/-3 1-xxx-2* AMP MCP Receptacle Finish Codes Finish Code Material -1 CuNiSi, pre-tin plated -2 CuNiSi, selective gold plated -3 CuNiSi, selective silver plated -4 CuNiSi, tin-silver pre-plated 1-xxx-1 CuNiSi, pre-tin plated 1-xxx-2 CuNiSi, selective gold plated 1-xxx-2* CuNiSi, min 1.27 µm selective gold plated 1-xxx-3 CuNiSi, selective silver plated PAGE 73 LEAVYSEAL Connectors WIRE SEALS Wire seals are required for connectors without an integrated rear seal to maintain an environmental seal. Contact Size Insulation Diameter (mm) Color Part Number 0.9-1.2 Green 1718705-1 Red 964971-1 Blue 1394133-1 1.4-1.9 Gray 963530-1 1.9-2.1 Yellow 964972-1 1.9-2.4 Orange 2112323-1 1.2-2.1 Blue 2.2-3.0 White 828905-1 1.4-2.0 Yellow 2177018-1 2.0-2.7 White 1394511-1 2.7-2.9 Red brown 1823111-1 3.4-3.7 Blue 1394512-1 4.0-4.5 Green 1719043-1 1.2-1.6 1.5K 2.8 6.3/4.8K 828904-1 828904-2 Package Quantity 10,000 1000 10,000 10,000 SEALING PLUGS Open cavities provide pathways for contaminates to enter the connectors. To maintain seal integrity, any unused cavity must be filled with the appropriate size sealing plug. Contact Size Wire Size 1.5K 3.6 mm 2.8 5.6 mm 6.3/4.8K 8.5 mm Color Part Number White 963531-1 Natural 1394132-1 Natural 828922-1 Green 828922-2 Transparent 967652-1 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Package Quantity 10,000 LEAVYSEAL Connectors Tooling Tools are specific to the contact style. To create a proper crimp and achieve the highest performance specifications, contacts must be crimped with the recommended tooling. HAND TOOL FOR AMP MCP CONTACTS Contact Size 1.5K 2.8 6.3/ 4.8K Tab Strip Form Tab Loose Piece Receptacle Strip Form Receptacle Loose Piece Tool P/N 1703278 964269 969028 1703279 964270 969029 - - 539663-2 (die) 539663-2 (frame) - - 1418884 1418885 5-1579001-3 (die) 539635-1 (frame) - - 1564324 1564325 4-1579016-0 (die) 539635-1 (frame) 962915 962916 963748 963749 965982 965983 - - 968882 968896 539725-2 (die) 539635-1 (frame) 962917 962918 962919 963742 963743 963744 - - 539757-2 (die) 539635-1 (frame) - - 1241410 1241412 1241411 1241413 539955-2 (die) 539635-1 (frame) - - 1241416 1241414 1241415 1241417 539956-2 (die) 539635-1 (frame) - - 1241418 1241419 3-1579021-7 (die) 539635-1 (frame) - - 539758-2 (die) 539635-1 (frame) 539737-2 (die) 539635-1 (frame) Description ERGOCRIMP hand tool and die assembly ERGOCRIMP hand tool and die assembly ERGOCRIMP hand tool and die assembly PAGE 75 LEAVYSEAL Connectors AUTOMATED FOR AMP MCP CONTACTS OCEAN end feed applicator Contact Size 1.5K Tab Strip Form Receptacle Strip Form 969028 - 964269 - 1703278 - - 1418884 - 1564324 962915 - 962916 - 2.8 2.8 965982 - - 968882 2.8 Applicator P/N Feed Type 2151056-1 Mechanical end feed 2151056-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151935-1 Mechanical end feed 2151935-2 Pneumatic end feed 2266180-1 Mechanical end feed 2266180-2 Pneumatic end feed 2266179-1 Mechanical end feed 2266179-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151469-1 Mechanical end feed 2151469-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151181-1 Mechanical end feed 2151181-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151260-1 Mechanical end feed 2151260-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151840-1 Mechanical end feed 2151840-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151559-1 Mechanical end feed 2151559-2 Pneumatic end feed Note: Applicators with additional feed styles are available, contact your representative INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS LEAVYSEAL Connectors AUTOMATED FOR AMP MCP CONTACTS (CONTINUED) Contact Size Tab Strip Form Receptacle Strip Form 962917 - 962918 - 962919 - - 1241410 - 1241412 6.3/4.8K - 1241416 - 1241414 - 1241418 Applicator P/N Description 2266535-1 Mechanical end feed 2266535-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151783-1 Mechanical end feed 2151783-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151782-1 Mechanical end feed 2151782-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151695-1 Mechanical end feed 2151695-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151234-1 Mechanical end feed 2151234-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151151-1 Mechanical end feed 2151151-2 Pneumatic end feed 2266490-1 Mechanical end feed 2266490-2 Pneumatic end feed 2151466-1 Mechanical end feed 2151466-2 Pneumatic end feed Note: Applicators with additional feed styles are available, contact your representative PAGE 77 LEAVYSEAL Connectors How To Instructions CONTACT INSERTION Step 1: Grasp crimped contact approximately one inch behind the contact barrel. Step 2: Verify the integrated secondary lock is in the unlocked position. Make sure the contact is in the correct orientation. Push contact straight into connector grommet until a click is felt. A slight tug will confirm that it is properly locked in place. Step 3: Push the integrated secondary lock into the locked position with a DTRT1 or a screwdriver. Step 2: Using the appropriate extraction tool, insert the blades into the contact cavity until they stop. Step 3: Pull contact wire assembly out of connector. CONTACT REMOVAL Step 1: Using a DT-RT1 or a screwdriver, unlock the integrated secondary lock. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Contents Superseal 1.0 Connector Overview.................... 80 Product Documentation......................................... 80 Performance Specifications.................................. 80 Material Specifications............................................ 80 Dimensions....................................................................81 Configurations..............................................................81 Ordering Information................................................82 Contacts....................................................................... 83 Tooling........................................................................... 84 Superseal 1.0 Connectors Superseal 1.0 Connector Overview The Superseal 1.0 mm connectors are designed to meet the increasing need for dependable printed circuit board applications in harsh environments. The Superseal headers are available with straight or right-angle pins. Various locking latch options and keying configurations are available. APPLICABLE PRODUCT DOCUMENTATION Additional documentation is available for assistance with Superseal 1.0 products. The following TE document numbers may be helpful: 1308072-2 (Catalog Section) 108-78140 (Product Specification) 114-78011 (Application Specification) SUPERSEAL 1.0 CONNECTOR PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Current: Up to 15 amps Temperature: Operating at temperatures -40°C to +125°C Durability: After cap housing is connected, the plug housing is mated and then 78.4 N force is applied in a rocking motion. 25 test cycles. Insulation Resistance: 100 megohms minimum. Test between adjacent contacts and between contact and earth with insulation resistance meter of 500 volts DC. Immersion: Per JIS D0203 Random Vibration: Tested in each of three mutually perpendicular axis. See Fig 8 in product document 108-78140. Dielectric Withstanding Voltage: Insulation does not breakdown at 1000 volts AC or 1600 volts DC for duration of 1 minute between contacts and between contact and earth. Voltage: 250 volts AC, DC MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS Grommet: Silicone rubber Housing: Thermoplastic TPA: Thermoplastic polyester INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Superseal 1.0 Connectors DIMENSIONS E B E A C D F Superseal 1.0 Plug Housing F G Superseal 1.0 Pin Header Overall Length A Overall Height B Overall Width C Overall Length Vertical D Overall Height E Overall Width F Overall Length 90° G 26 1.26 (32.1) 1.36 (34.5) 1.26 (32.1) 1.14 (29.0) 1.23 (31.4) 1.55 (39.5) 1.44 (36.5) 34 1.26 (32.1) 1.49 (38.0) 1.50 (38.2) 1.14 (29.0) 1.23 (31.4) 1.79 (45.5) 1.44 (36.5) 60 - - - - 1.23 (31.4) 3.07 (78.0) 1.44 (36.5) Cavity Dimensions are for reference only. CONFIGURATIONS 26 Positions 26 size 1.0 mm 34 Positions 34 size 1.0 mm 60 Positions 60 size 1.0 mm PAGE 81 Superseal 1.0 Connectors ORDERING INFORMATION Position 26 Pin Header Plug Housing Keying Type Locking 9-6437287-8 3-1437290-7 1 (4 row) Upper 9-6437287-9 3-1437290-8 2 (4 row) Upper 6473423-1 1473416-1 3 (4 row) Upper 6473423-2 1473416-2 4 (4 row) Upper 5-6447223-0 3-1437290-7 1 (4 row) Lower 6437288-4 3-1437290-8 2 (4 row) Lower 2-6437285-8 2-1437285-2 1 (4 row) Double 2-6437285-9 1-1447232-7 2 (4 row) Double 6437288-6 3-1437290-7 1 (4 row, vertical) Upper 6473418-1 3-1437290-8 2 (4 row, vertical) Upper 6473418-2 1473416-1 3 (4 row, vertical) Upper 1 (2 row) Upper 1 (2 row) Lower 6473711-1 6473711-2 34 1473712-1 6437288-1 4-1437290-0 1 (4 row) Upper 6437288-2 4-1437290-1 2 (4 row) Upper 2-6437285-5 4-1437290-0 1 (4 row) Lower 2-6437285-6 4-1437290-1 2 (4 row) Lower 3-6437285-0 2-1437285-3 1 (4 row) Double 3-6437285-1 3-1437290-9 2 (4 row) Double 2-6447232-3 4-1437290-0 1 (4 row, vertical) Upper 2-6447232-4 4-1437290-1 2 (4 row, vertical) Upper 6437288-3 3-1437290-7 (26P), 4-1437290-0 (34P) 1 (4 row) Upper 6473427-1 1473416-1 (26P), 4-1437290-1 (34P) 2 + 3 (4 row) Upper 6437288-5 3-1437290-7 (26P), 4-143790-0 (34P) 1 (4 row) Lower 3-6437285-2 2-1437285-2 (26P), 2-1437285-3 (34P) 1 (4 row) Double 60 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Superseal 1.0 Connectors Contacts The Superseal 1.0 mm connectors commonly use the AMP Superseal double spring, stamped & formed contact system. 1.0 MM CONTACT PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Durability 25 cycles, per “Kojiri” (rocking motion) durability test Contact Retention (between contact and housing) 1.0mm ≥ 58.8N Current Rating Up to 15 amps, consult TE product specification 108-78140 Crimp Tensile Strength Contact Size Tensile Strength .5mm2 ≥ 88.2N .85 mm2 ≥ 127.4N 1.25 mm2 ≥ 176.4N 1.0 MM STAMPED & FORMED CONTACTS FOR SUPERSEAL 1.0 Stamped & Formed Receptacles - 1.0 mm Size 1.0 mm Receptacle Strip Form Wire Size (mm2) Insulation Diameter (mm) 3-1447221-4 0.5 1.6-2.2 .75-.85 1.6-2.4 1.25 1.9-2.2 3-1447221-3 Finish Copper alloy Gold over nickel (contact part), Tin over Nickel (crimp area) SEALING PLUGS Open cavities provide pathways for contaminates to enter the connectors. To maintain seal integrity, any unused cavity must be filled with the appropriate size sealing plug. Contact Size Color Part Number 1.0 mm White 4-1437284-3 PAGE 83 Superseal 1.0 Connectors Tooling Tools are specific to the contact style. To create a proper crimp and achieve the highest performance specifications, contacts must be crimped with the recommended tooling. HAND TOOLS FOR 1.0 MM CONTACTS Receptacle P/N 3-1447221-3 3-1447221-4 Tool P/N Description 1454509-1 CERTI-CRIMP straight action hand tool with fixed dies AUTOMATED TOOLING FOR 1.0 MM CONTACTS Receptacle P/N 3-1447221-3 3-1447221-4 Applicator P/N Description 2151705-1 OCEAN end feed applicator with mechanical feed 2151705-2 OCEAN end feed applicator with pneumatic feed Note: Applicators with additional feed styles are available, contact your representative INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Contents AEC Series Overview............................................... 86 Performance Specifications.................................. 86 Material Specifications............................................ 86 Dimensions...................................................................87 Configurations.............................................................87 Ordering Information............................................... 88 Accessories.................................................................. 89 How To Instructions.......................................... 89-90 AEC Series AEC Series Overview DEUTSCH AEC series connectors are environmentally sealed, heavy duty electrical connectors that accept size 16 contacts. The AEC series connectors are constructed of rugged thermoplastic and offer several keying options. DEUTSCH CONNECTOR PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Temperature: Operating at temperatures -55°C to +125°C Durability: No electrical or mechanical defects after 100 cycles of engagement and disengagement. Vibration: No unlocking or unmating and exhibits no mechanical or physical damage after sinusoidal vibration levels of 20 G’s at 10 to 2000 Hz in each of the three mutually perpendicular planes. No electrical discontinuities longer than 1 microsecond. Fluid Resistance: Connectors show no damage when exposed to most fluids used in industrial applications. Insulation Resistance: 1000 megohms minimum at 25°C. Immersion: IP68 rating Moisture Resistance: Properly wired and mated connections will withstand immersion under three feet of water without loss of electronic qualities or leakage. Dielectric Withstanding Voltage: Current leakage less than 2 milliamps at 1500 volts AC. Thermal Cycle: No cracking, chipping or leaking after 20 test cycles from -55°C to +125°C. MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS Grommet: Silicone rubber Jackscrew: Stainless steel Plug Threaded Stainless steel Inserts: Receptacle Threaded Inserts: Stainless steel/brass Shell: Glass filled PEI INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS AEC Series DIMENSIONS A D B E C F AEC Plug Cavity 40 AEC Receptacle Overall Length A Overall Height B Overall Width C Overall Length D Overall Height E Overall Width F 1.440 (36.58) 1.778 (45.16) 1.894 (48.11) 1.642 (41.71) 1.944 (49.38) 1.828 (46.43) Dimensions are for reference only. CONFIGURATION Keying Options A A key B B key C C key D D key U Universal key Insert Arrangement XX-XX X size XX X, X, X Part Number Number and Size of Cavities Note Do not over torque jackscrew. The recommended torque rating for the AEC series plug jackscrew when tightening is 25-28 IN-LB (2.86-3.16 N.M.). AEC1*-40*** 40 size 16 A, B, C, D, U PAGE 87 AEC Series PART NUMBERING SYSTEM Part Number AEC - 1 __ - __ __ * * - ****  Special Modifications Series Contact Size 1 Wire Seals Size 16 Contacts Blank Standard Seal E Style 4 In-line Receptacle 6 Plug Extra Thin Wall Seal Key A Configuration B C D U Contacts P Pin S Socket ORDERING INFORMATION Here are some of the common part numbers in the AEC series. Several additional connectors may be available. Position Keying Plug Receptacle A AEC16-40SA AEC14-40PA B AEC16-40SB AEC14-40PB C AEC16-40SC AEC14-40PC D AEC16-40SD AEC14-40PD 40 WIRE SEALING RANGES The wire sealing range is the recommended outside diameter of the wire insulation required to maintain an environmental seal in the rear connector cavities. Contact Size Standard Seal Thin Seal T-Seal Extra Thin Seal E-Seal 16 14-20 AWG (2.0-0.5mm2) .100-.134 (2.54-3.40) .088-.134 (2.23-3.40) .053-.120 (1.35-3.05) INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS AEC Series Accessories Dust caps and boots are available for use with AEC series connectors. The dust caps are designed to help provide protection to the connector interface when the connector halves are not mated. The boots are aesthetically appealing and provide increased protection from dirt, paint overspray, and pressure washing. Dust Cap Description Part Number Dust cap, 40 way receptacle, environmentally sealed 0504-002-4001 Dust cap, 40 way receptacle, non-environmentally sealed 0515-009-4005 Dust cap, 40 way plug, non-environmentally sealed 0515-010-4005 ut LAD D l u si v e t ion xc o E Boot Description D i s t ri b Part Number Boot, 40 way plug or receptacle, black, step-down AEC40-BTSTPDWN *Distorting the boots can lessen their longevity How To Instructions CONTACT INSERTION Step 1: Grasp crimped contact approximately one inch behind the contact barrel. Step 2: Hold connector with rear grommet facing you. Step 3: Push contact straight into connector grommet until a click is felt. A slight tug will confirm that it is properly locked in place. PAGE 89 AEC Series CONTACT REMOVAL Step 1: With rear insert toward you, snap appropriate size removal tool over the wire of contact to be removed. . Step 2: Slide tool along the wire into the insert cavity until it engages contact and resistance is felt. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Step 3: Pull contact wire assembly out of connector. Contents DRB Series Overview................................................92 Performance Specifications...................................92 Material Specifications.............................................92 Dimensions.................................................................. 93 Configurations............................................................ 93 Ordering Information............................................... 94 Required Components..................................... 95-96 Accessories...................................................................97 How To Instructions...........................................97-98 DRB Series DRB Series Overview DEUTSCH DRB series connectors are heavy duty connectors suitable for bulkhead applications. They are designed to accommodate multiple wire gauges and feature high pin counts, including 48, 60, 102, and 128 cavities. To increase the design flexibility, the DRB series offers several mounting flange options and wire arrangements. The DRB series is suited for on- and off-highway applications, marine, industrial, and agriculture markets in harsh environments. DEUTSCH CONNECTOR PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Temperature: Operating at temperatures -55°C to +125°C Durability: No electrical or mechanical defects after 100 cycles of engagement and disengagement. Vibration: No unlocking or unmating and exhibits no mechanical or physical damage after sinusoidal vibration levels of 20 G’s at 10 to 2000 Hz in each of the three mutually perpendicular planes. No electrical discontinuities longer than 1 microsecond. Fluid Resistance: Connectors show no damage when exposed to most fluids used in industrial applications. Insulation Resistance: 1000 megohms minimum at 25°C. Immersion: IP68 rating Moisture Resistance: Properly wired and mated connections will withstand immersion under three feet of water without loss of electronic qualities or leakage. Dielectric Withstanding Voltage: Current leakage less than 2 milliamps at 1500 volts AC. Thermal Cycle: No cracking, chipping or leaking after 20 test cycles from -55°C to +125°C. MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS Flange Body: Glass filled PA Flange Clip: Spring steel Grommet: Silicone rubber Jackscrew: Stainless steel Shell: Glass filled PA Wedgelocks: Glass filled PBT INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DRB Series DIMENSIONS A D B E C F DRB Plug DRB Receptacle Overall Length A Overall Height B Overall Width C Overall Length D Overall Height E Overall Width F 48 & 60 1.406 (35.71) 2.606 (66.19) 2.606 (66.19) 2.077 (52.76) 2.606 (66.19) 2.606 (66.19) 102 1.778 (45.16) 2.966 (75.34) 4.951 (125.76) 2.291 (58.19) 2.966 (75.34) 4.951 (125.76) 128 1.748 (44.40) 2.966 (75.34) 4.951 (125.76) 2.291 (58.19) 2.966 (75.34) 4.951 (125.76) Cavity Dimensions are for reference only. CONFIGURATIONS Keying Options A A key B B key C C key D D key DRB1*-48** 12 size 12 12 size 16 24 size 20 A, B, C, D Insert Arrangement XX-XX X size XX X, X, X DRB1*-60** 12 size 16 48 size 20 A, B, C, D DRB1*-102*** 2 size 4 4 size 8 16 size 12 80 size 16 A, B, C, D Part Number Number and Size of Cavities DRB1*-128*** 16 size 12 112 size 16 A, B, C, D PAGE 93 DRB Series PART NUMBERING SYSTEM Part Number DRB 16 - 60 S * E - **** Special Modifications Series L018 Wire Router Style 16 Plug 12 Flange Mount Receptacle Wire Seals E Configuration NE Contacts Environmental Non-Environmental Key P Pin S Socket A B C D ORDERING INFORMATION Here are some of the common part numbers in the DRB series. Several additional connectors may be available. Position 48 60 102 128 Keying Plug Receptacle Key A DRB16-48SAE-L018 DRB12-48PAE-L018 Key B DRB16-48SBE-L018 DRB12-48PBE-L018 Key C DRB16-48SCE-L018 DRB12-48PCE-L018 Key D DRB16-48SDE-L018 DRB12-48PDE-L018 Key A DRB16-60SAE-L018 DRB12-60PAE-L018 Key B DRB16-60SBE-L018 DRB12-60PBE-L018 Key C DRB16-60SCE-L018 DRB12-60PCE-L018 Key D DRB16-60SDE-L018 DRB12-60PDE-L018 Key A DRB16-102SAE-L018 DRB12-102PAE-L018 Key B DRB16-102SBE-L018 DRB12-102PBE-L018 Key C DRB16-102SCE-L018 DRB12-102PCE-L018 Key D DRB16-102SDE-L018 DRB12-102PDE-L018 Key A DRB16-128SAE-L018 DRB12-128PAE-L018 Key B DRB16-128SBE-L018 DRB12-128PBE-L018 Key C DRB16-128SCE-L018 DRB12-128PCE-L018 Key D DRB16-128SDE-L018 DRB12-128PDE-L018 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DRB Series WIRE SEALING RANGE The wire sealing range is the recommended outside diameter of the wire insulation required to maintain an environmental seal in the rear connector cavities. Contact Size Standard Seal Extra Thin Seal E-Seal 20 16-22 AWG (1.0-0.35mm2) .040-.095 (1.02-2.41) .040-.095 (1.02-2.41) 16 14-20 AWG (2.0-0.5mm2) .100-.134 (2.54-3.40) .053-.120 (1.35-3.05) 12 10-14 AWG (5.0-2.0mm2) .134-.170 (3.40-4.32) .097-.158 (2.46-4.01) 8 8-10 AWG (8.0-5.0mm2) .190-.240 (4.83-6.10) .135-.220 (3.43-5.59) .280-.292 (7.11-7.42) .261-.292 (6.63-7.42) 4 6 AWG (13.0mm2) Required Components A complete DRB assembly requires a wedgelock for each plug and receptacle and a mounting flange. There are several flange options to accommodate design requirements. The wedgelocks are required to confirm proper contact placement. Plug Plug Wedgelock(s) Flange Receptacle Wedgelock(s) Receptacle PAGE 95 DRB Series FLANGE OPTIONS Accepts Connectors Description DRBF-2* (1) DRB 48 or 60 way Single mounting flange for one 48 or 60 way DRB plug and receptacle mated pair DRBF-3** (2) DRB 48 or 60 ways Double mounting flange for any combination of two 48 or 60 way DRB plug and receptacle mated pairs DRBF-1* (1) DRB 102 way or (1) DRB 128 way Single mounting flange for the 102 or 128 way DRB plug and receptacle mated pair DRBM-3* (1) DRB 102 way or (1) DRB 128 way Single mounting flange for the 102 or 128 way DRB plug and receptacle mated pair, includes two 125 amp mounting posts Part Number *A, B, C, D keying available, contact your representative SECONDARY WEDGELOCKS DEUTSCH DRB electrical connectors require secondary wedgelocks which are sold separately. The wedgelocks confirm proper contact alignment and offer keying options within each connector. Secondary wedgelocks are assembled at the mating interfaces and click into place. Receptacle Wedgelocks Plug Wedgelocks WB-48P* Wedgelock for 48 way receptacle WB-48S* Wedgelock for 48 way plug WB-60P* Wedgelock for 60 way receptacle WB-60S* Wedgelock for 60 way plug WB-51P*L Left wedgelock for 102 way receptacle WB-51S*L Left wedgelock for 102 way plug WB-51P*R Right wedgelock for 102 way receptacle WB-51S*R Right wedgelock for 102 way plug WB-64P* Wedgelock for 128 way receptacle (requires two) WB-64S* Wedgelock for 128 way plug (requires two) *A, B, C, D keying available *A, B, C, D keying available INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DRB Series Accessories ut LAD D l u si v e t ion xc o E BOOTS D i s t ri b Boots provide a professional looking finishing touch for DEUTSCH DRB series connectors. Made of durable plastisol, these slip-on boots are not only aesthetically appealing, but also provide increased protection from dirt, paint overspray, and pressure washing. The plastisol boots are rated from -20°F to +212°F (-28°C to +100°C) and offer a slip-on design making installation quick and easy. Part Number Description DRB48-60-BT 48 way plug or receptacle boot, black DRB48-60-BT 60 way plug or receptacle boot, black DRB102-BT 102/128 way plug or receptacle boot, black DRB102-BT90DEG 102/128 way plug or receptacle boot, 90° bend, black *Distorting the boots can lessen their longevity How To Instructions CONTACT INSERTION Step 1: Hold connector with rear grommet/wire router cap facing you. Step 2: Push contact straight into contact cavity until a click is heard/felt. A slight tug will confirm the contact is inserted correctly. Step 3: Once all contacts are in place, insert wedgelock by lining up the keyway. The wedgelock will press into place. PAGE 97 DRB Series CONTACT REMOVAL Step 1: Remove wedgelock using a screwdriver. Pull wedgelock straight out. Step 2: To remove contacts, gently pull wire backwards, while at the same time releasing the locking finger by moving it away from the contact with a screwdriver. ASSEMBLY Step 1: Wedgelocks should be pressed firmly in place, with only a slight gap showing between the wedgelock and connector. Step 2: If the wedgelock will not go all the way in, check to make sure all of the contacts are properly seated. Improper assembly can cause the jackscrew to be stripped during assembly. To prevent damage, the jackscrew will strip out before the threads in the connector are damaged. If the jackscrew becomes stripped, please replace the jackscrew and the push nut. Step 3: Contacts should be fully inserted into the connector, with the locking fingers in place under the shoulder of the contact. If a contact is not fully inserted, the retention finger will prevent the wedgelock from pressing into place. Note Step 4: When mating the plug with the receptacle, confirm that the plug is not being pulled into the receptacle at an angle by the jackscrew. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Do not over torque jackscrew. The recommended torque rating for the DRB series plug jackscrew when tightening is 30-35 IN-LB (3.38-3.95 N.M.). Contents DRC Series Overview............................................. 100 Performance Specifications................................ 100 Material Specifications.......................................... 100 Dimensions..................................................................101 Configurations...........................................................102 Ordering Information..................................... 103-104 Accessories........................................................ 106-107 How To Instructions................................................108 DRC Series DRC Series Overview The environmentally sealed DEUTSCH DRC series is a rectangular connector series that offers insert arrangements of 24, 40, 50, 60, 64, 70, and 76 cavities and accepts size 12, 16, and 20 contacts. Several mounting options are available including in-line, flange mount, and PCB mount. DEUTSCH CONNECTOR PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Temperature: Operating at temperatures -55°C to +125°C Durability: No electrical or mechanical defects after 100 cycles of engagement and disengagement. Vibration: No unlocking or unmating and exhibits no mechanical or physical damage after sinusoidal vibration levels of 20 G’s at 10 to 2000 Hz in each of the three mutually perpendicular planes. No electrical discontinuities longer than 1 microsecond. Fluid Resistance: Connectors show no damage when exposed to most fluids used in industrial applications. Insulation Resistance: 1000 megohms minimum at 25°C. Immersion: IP68 rating Moisture Resistance: Properly wired and mated connections will withstand immersion under three feet of water without loss of electronic qualities or leakage. Dielectric Withstanding Voltage: Current leakage less than 2 milliamps at 1500 volts AC. Thermal Cycle: No cracking, chipping or leaking after 20 test cycles from -55°C to +125°C. MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS Grommet: Silicone rubber Insert Retainer: Unfilled PEI Jackscrew: Stainless steel Receptacle Stainless steel/Brass Threaded Inserts: Shell: Glass filled PA, Glass filled PPS INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DRC Series DIMENSIONS D A B E C F DRC Plug Cavity Overall Length Overall Height A B DRC Receptacle Overall Width Overall Length Overall Height C D E Overall Width F 24 (sz. 20) 1.435 (36.45) 1.244 (31.60) 2.004 (50.90) 1.785 (45.34) 1.500 (38.10) 3.104 (78.84) 24 (sz. 16) 1.600 (40.64) 1.148 (29.16) 2.100 (53.34) 1.742 (44.25) 1.202 (30.53) 2.154 (54.71) 38 1.435 (36.45) 1.274 (32.36) 2.700 (68.58) - - - 40 (sz. 20) 1.380 (35.05) 1.244 (31.60) 2.700 (68.58) 1.785 (45.34) 1.500 (38.10) 3.800 (96.52) 40 (sz. 16) 1.597 (40.56) 1.202 (30.53) 2.868 (72.85) 1.699 (43.15) 1.202 (30.53) 2.908 (73.86) 50 1.435 (36.45) 1.408 (35.76) 2.700 (68.58) - 1.987 (50.47) 3.094 (78.59) 60 1.435 (36.45) 1.448 (36.78) 2.700 (68.58) - 2.161 (54.89) 3.094 (78.59) 64 - - - 1.785 (45.34) 1.500 (38.10) 5.866 (149.00) 70 1.643 (41.73) 1.421 (36.09) 4.094 (103.99) 1.757 (44.63) 1.421 (36.09) 4.094 (103.99) 76 - - - 1.115 (28.32) 1.827 (46.41) 5.686 (144.42) Dimensions are for reference only. CONNECTOR STYLES In-line Receptacle Flange Mount Receptacle PCB Receptacle Standard Plug PAGE 101 DRC Series CONFIGURATIONS Connector Styles I In-line F Flange Mount Receptacle P PCB Receptacle DRC2*-24** 24 size 20 I, F, P DRC2*-40** 40 size 20 F, P DRC2*-60** 60 size 20 P Insert Arrangement Part Number Number and Size of Cavities XX-XX X size XX X, X, X DRC1*-24** 24 size 1 I, F, P DRC26-38** 34 size 20, 4 size 12 (Plug for DRC20-76P****) DRC1*-40** 40 size 16 I, F, P DRC2*-50** 50 size 20 P DRC2*-64** 64 size 20 P DRC1*-70** 70 size 16 I, F, P INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DRC20-76P**** 68 size 20, 8 size 12 P DRC Series PART NUMBERING SYSTEM Part Number DRC 14 - 40 P * X - **** Series Special Modifications Contact Size Wire Seals 1 Size 16 Contacts 2 Size 20 Contacts Blank Standard Seal Style T Thin Wall Seal (Size 16 Only) E Extra Thin Wall Seal (Size 16 Only) 0 Molded-in Contacts 2 Flange Mount Receptacle Key (if applicable 3 90° PCB Receptacle Contacts 4 In-line Receptacle P Pin 6 Plug S Socket 8 Keyed Plug (40 Pin Size 16 Only) Configuration ORDERING INFORMATION Here are some of the common part numbers in the DRC series. Several additional connectors may be available. Position 24 (sz. 20) 24 (sz. 16) 38 (sz. 20) Key Plug Receptacle In-line Receptacle Flange Receptacle PCB A DRC26-24SA - - DRC23-24PA (90°) B DRC26-24SB - - DRC23-24PB (90°) C DRC26-24SC - - DRC23-24PC (90°) D DRC26-24SD - - DRC23-24PD (90°) A DRC16-24SA DRC14-24PA DRC12-24PA B DRC16-24SB DRC14-24PB DRC12-24PB C DRC16-24SC DRC14-24PC DRC12-24PC D DRC16-24SD DRC14-24PD DRC12-24PD 01 DRC26-38S01-P017 - - 02 DRC26-38S02-P017 - - DRC10-24PA (180°) DRC13-24PA (90°) DRC10-24PB (180°) DRC13-24PB (90°) DRC10-24PC (180°) DRC13-24PC (90°) DRC10-24PD (180°) DRC13-24PD (90°) DRC20-76P0102 (180°) PAGE 103 DRC Series ORDERING INFORMATION (CONTINUED) Position 40 (sz. 20) 40 (sz. 16) Key Plug Receptacle In-line Receptacle Flange Receptacle PCB A DRC26-40SA - DRC22-40PA DRC23-40PA (90°) B DRC26-40SB - DRC22-40PB DRC23-40PB (90°) C DRC26-40SC - DRC22-40PC DRC23-40PC (90°) D DRC26-40SD - DRC22-40PD DRC23-40PD (90°) A DRC18-40SA DRC14-40PA DRC12-40PA B DRC18-40SB DRC14-40PB DRC12-40PB C DRC18-40SC DRC14-40PC DRC12-40PC D DRC18-40SD DRC14-40PD DRC12-40PD 01 02 DRC26-50S01 DRC26-50S02 - - - - 50 (sz. 20) 03 DRC26-50S03 - - 04 DRC26-50S04 - - DRC10-40PA (180°) DRC13-40PA (90°) DRC10-40PB (180°) DRC13-40PB (90°) DRC10-40PC (180°) DRC13-40PC (90°) DRC10-40PD (180°) DRC13-40PD (90°) DRC20-50P01 (180°, outside mount) DRC22-50P01 (180°, inside mount) DRC20-50P02 (180°, outside mount) DRC22-50P02 (180°, inside mount) DRC20-50P03 (180°, outside mount) DRC22-50P03 (180°, inside mount) DRC20-50P04 (180°, outside mount) DRC22-50P04 (180°, inside mount) 60 (sz. 20) 05 DRC26-60S05 - - - 06 DRC26-60S06 - - - 07 DRC26-60S07 - - - 64 (sz. 20) AA DRC26-24SA/ DRC26-40SA - - DRC23-64PAA (90°) A DRC16-70SA DRC14-70PA DRC12-70PA DRC13-70PA B DRC16-70SB DRC14-70PB DRC12-70PB DRC13-70PB C DRC16-70SC DRC14-70PC DRC12-70PC DRC13-70PC D DRC16-70SD DRC14-70PD DRC12-70PD DRC13-70PD 01/02 DRC26-38S01-P017/ DRC26-38S02-P017 - - DRC20-76P0102 (180°) 70 (sz. 16) 76 (sz. 20 and sz. 12) INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DRC Series WIRE SEALING RANGE The wire sealing range is the recommended outside diameter of the wire insulation required to maintain an environmental seal in the rear connector cavities. Contact Size Standard Seal Thin Seal T-Seal Extra Thin Seal E-Seal 20 16-22 AWG (1.0-0.35mm2) .040-.095 (1.02-2.41) .040-.095 (1.02-2.41) .040-.095 (1.02-2.41) 16 14-20 AWG (2.0-0.5mm2) .100-.134 (2.54-3.40) .088-.134 (2.23-3.40) .053-.120 (1.35-3.05) 12 10-14 AWG (6.0-2.0mm2) .097-.170 (2.46-4.95) .113-.170 (2.87-4.32) .097-.158 (2.46-4.01) MATING CRITERIA DEUTSCH DRC series plugs are keyed to provide positive alignment and to prevent mis-mating. Jackscrew Key Note Do not over torque jackscrew. The recommended torque rating for the DRC series plug jackscrew when tightening is 25-28 IN-LB (2.82-3.16 N.M.). PAGE 105 DRC Series Accessories Several accessory items are available to complement the connectors including boots, gaskets, backshells, and wire routers. Accessories are designed to complete the application and meet a wide array of design requirements such as providing additional protection and offering increased aesthetics. BACKSHELLS DEUTSCH DRC series backshells are designed to snap onto the back of the connectors and accept convoluted tubing. The rigid, durable backshells offer a high level of protection, provide strain relief, and improve aesthetics. Connector Cavities Part Number Description 38 0528-003-3805 90° backshell to the side, plug 38 0528-004-3805 90° backshell, plug 38 0528-005-3805 90° low profile backshell, plug 40 0515-015-4005 Wire router, plug 50 0528-001-5005 90° backshell, plug 60 0528-002-6005 90° backshell, plug 60 0528-007-6005 90° backshell to the side, plug 70 0515-029-7005 Straight wire router, plug 70 0515-031-7005 Straight wire router, plug or receptacle, 70 0528-006-7005 Straight backshell, plug or receptacle, requires two halves and wire router 70 0528-012-7005 90° backshell to the side, plug or receptacle, without tubing rib INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DRC Series ut LAD D l u si v e t ion xc o E BOOTS D i s t ri b Boots provide a professional looking finishing touch for DEUTSCH DRC series connectors. Made of durable plastisol, these slip-on boots are not only aesthetically appealing, but also provide increased protection from dirt, paint overspray, and pressure washing. The plastisol boots are rated from -20°F to +212°F (-28°C to +100°C) and offer a slip-on design making installation quick and easy. Part Number Description DRC24-BT 24 way boot, size 16 contact arrangements, black DRC26-24BT 24 way boot, size 20 contact arrangements, black DRC40-BT 40 way boot, size 16 contact arrangements, black DRC40-BT90DEG 40 way boot, size 16 contact arrangements, 90° bend, black DRC26-40BT 40 way boot, size 20 contact arrangements, black DRC70-BT 70 way boot, size 16 contact arrangements, black *Distorting the boots can lessen their longevity ut LAD D l u si v e t ion xc o E GASKETS D i s t ri b Moisture, dirt, salt, sand, and road debris can all work their way into electrical panels through unsealed mounting flanges. Rated to operate in environments from -70°F to +225 F (-56°C to +107°C), these rugged high quality neoprene gaskets form a tight seal between the panel face and connector flange to help keep out destructive elements. The gaskets have a thickness of .125” and the material meets the UL-94-HBF, Mil-R-6130C, and FMVSS-302 flammability specifications. Gasket Part Number Connector Part Number DRC24-GKT DRC12-24P** DRC40-GKT DRC12-40P** DRC70-GKT DRC12-70P** PAGE 107 DRC Series How To Instructions CONTACT INSERTION Step 1: Grasp crimped contact approximately one inch behind the contact barrel. Step 2: Hold connector with rear grommet facing you. Step 3: Push contact straight into connector grommet until a click is felt. A slight tug will confirm that it is properly locked in place. Step 2: Slide tool along the wire into the insert cavity until it engages contact and resistance is felt. Step 3: Pull contact wire assembly out of connector. CONTACT REMOVAL Step 1: With rear insert toward you, snap appropriate size removal tool over the wire of contact to be removed. . INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Contents DT Family Overview.................................................110 Product Documentation.......................................... 111 Performance Specifications................................... 111 Material Specifications............................................. 111 Dimensions........................................................... 112-113 Configurations............................................................114 Ordering Information........................................ 115-116 Required Components..................................... 117-118 Special Modifications.......................................118-120 Accessories.......................................................... 121-127 DT Family Printed Circuit Board........................ 128 DTMH Series & High Temperature Modification.......................................................129-130 DTV Series................................................................... 131 How To Instructions................................................ 132 DT Family DT Family Overview DEUTSCH DT, DTM, and DTP series environmentally sealed connectors are designed for cable to cable and cable to board applications. The DT connectors are used in harsh environment applications where even a small degradation in connection may be critical. Thermoplastic housings offer a wide operating temperature range and silicone rear wire and interface seals allow the connectors to withstand conditions of extreme temperature and moisture. The DEUTSCH DT series general purpose connectors will provide reliability and performance on the engine or transmission, under the hood, on the chassis, or in the cab. DT SERIES OVERVIEW DTM SERIES OVERVIEW DEUTSCH DT series connectors offer field proven reliability and rugged quality. The DT design strengths include optional flange mounting, multi-pin arrangements, and design flexibility. The DT series offers the designer the ability to use multiple size 16 contacts, each with 13 amp continuous capacity, within a single shell. DEUTSCH DTM series connectors offer solutions to your smaller wire gauge applications. Building on the DT design strengths, the DTM connector line was developed to fill the need for lower amperage, multipin connectors. The DTM series offers the designer the ability to use multiple size 20 contacts, each with 7.5 amp continuous capacity, within a single shell. DTP SERIES OVERVIEW DEUTSCH DTP series connectors provide solutions for your power application requirements. Building on both the DT and DTM design strengths, the DTP connector line was developed to fill the need for higher amperage, multi-pin connectors. The DTP series offers the designer the ability to use multiple size 12 contacts, each with 25 amp continuous capacity, within a single shell. The DTP connectors are currently available in two and four pin configurations. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DT Family APPLICABLE PRODUCT DOCUMENTATION Additional documentation is available for assistance with DT Family products. The following TE Connectivity document numbers may be helpful: 108-151009 (Product Specification, DT series) 108-151010 (Product Specification, DTM series) DEUTSCH CONNECTOR PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Temperature: Operating at temperatures -55°C to +125°C • DTMH series: -55°C to +150°C Durability: No electrical or mechanical defects after 100 cycles of engagement and disengagement. Vibration: No unlocking or unmating and exhibits no mechanical or physical damage after sinusoidal vibration levels of 20 G’s at 10 to 2000 Hz in each of the three mutually perpendicular planes. No electrical discontinuities longer than 1 microsecond. Fluid Resistance: Connectors show no damage when exposed to most fluids used in industrial applications. Insulation Resistance: 1000 megohms minimum at 25°C. Immersion: IP68 rating Moisture Resistance: Properly wired and mated connections will withstand immersion under three feet of water without loss of electronic qualities or leakage. Dielectric Withstanding Voltage: Current leakage less than 2 milliamps at 1500 volts AC. Thermal Cycle: No cracking, chipping or leaking after 20 test cycles from -55°C to +125°C. MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS (DT, DTM, DTMH, DTP, DTV SERIES) Grommet: Silicone rubber Receptacle Silicone rubber Interfacial Seal: Receptacle Threaded Inserts: Stainless steel Shell: Glass filled PA Wedgelocks: Glass filled PBT PAGE 111 DT Family DT SERIES DIMENSIONS E B A C D F DT Plug DT Receptacle Overall Length A Overall Height B Overall Width C Overall Length D Overall Height E Overall Width F 2 1.118 (28.4) .628 (15.95) .591 (15.01) 1.708 (43.38) .670 (17.02) .675 (17.15) 3 1.118 (28.4) .934 (23.72) .718 (18.23) 1.698 (43.13) .973 (24.71) .832 (21.13) 4 1.218 (30.94) .724 (18.39) .716 (18.19) 1.808 (45.92) .776 (19.71) .820 (20.83) 6 1.218 (30.94) .891 (22.63) .716 (18.19) 1.808 (45.92) .951 (24.16) .820 (20.83) 8 1.217 (30.91) .776 (19.71) 1.465 (37.21) 1.798 (45.67) 1.000 (25.40) 1.435 (36.45) 12 1.218 (30.94) .716 (18.19) 1.597 (40.56) 1.808 (45.92) .876 (22.25) 1.597 (40.56) Cavity Dimensions are for reference only. DTM SERIES DIMENSIONS E B C A F DTM Plug D DTM Receptacle Overall Length A Overall Height B Overall Width C Overall Length D Overall Height E Overall Width F 2 1.085 (27.56) .508 (12.90) .475 (12.07) 1.620 (41.15) .638 (16.21) .651 (16.54) 3 1.085 (27.56) .551 (14.00) .640 (16.26) 1.620 (41.15) .638 (16.21) .861 (20.73) 4 1.185 (30.10) .695 (17.65) .600 (15.24) 1.720 (43.69) .772 (19.61) .756 (19.20) 6 1.185 (30.10) .817 (20.75) .600 (15.24) 1.720 (43.69) .937 (23.80) .756 (19.20) 8 1.185 (30.10) .600 (15.24) 1.245 (31.62) 1.720 (43.69) .796 (20.22) 1.245 (31.62) 12 1.185 (30.10) .600 (15.24) 1.575 (40.01) 1.720 (43.69) .796 (20.22) 1.575 (40.01) Cavity Dimensions are for reference only. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DT Family DTP SERIES DIMENSIONS E B D A C F DTP Plug DTP Receptacle Overall Length A Overall Height B Overall Width C Overall Length D Overall Height E Overall Width F 2 1.364 (34.65) .711 (18.06) .732 (18.59) 1.861 (47.27) .869 (22.07) .872 (22.15) 4 1.364 (34.65) .960 (24.38) .868 (22.05) 1.861 (47.27) 1.048 (26.62) 1.060 (26.92) Cavity Dimensions are for reference only. PAGE 113 DT Family DT FAMILY CONFIGURATIONS Keying Options A A key B B key C C key D D key Insert Arrangement XX-XX X size XX X, X, X Part Number Number and Size of Cavities DT SERIES CONFIGURATIONS DT0*-2* 2 size 16 DT0*-3* 3 size 16 DT0*-4* 4 size 16 DT0*-6* 6 size 16 DT0*-08** 8 size 16 A, B, C, D DTM0*-6* 6 size 20 DTM0*-08** 8 size 20 A, B, C, D DT0*-12** 12 size 16 A, B, C, D DTM SERIES CONFIGURATIONS DTM0*-2* 2 size 20 DTM0*-3* 3 size 20 DTM0*-4* 4 size 20 DTP SERIES CONFIGURATIONS DTP0*-2* 2 size 12 DTP0*-4* 4 size 12 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DTM0*-12** 12 size 20 A, B, C, D DT Family PART NUMBERING SYSTEM Part Number DT* 06 - 2 S * - **** Series Special Modifications Blank DT series Key (if applicable) F DTF series M DTM series MF P Contacts DTMF series DTP series P Pin S Socket Configuration Style 04 Receptacle Note 06 Plug See part numbering systems 13 Receptacle, 90° pins 15 Receptacle, straight pins for DTV and DTMH series on pages 129-131. DT SERIES ORDERING INFORMATION Here are some of the common part numbers in the DT series. Several additional connectors may be available. Keying Plug Receptacle Plug Reduced Dia. Seals Receptacle Reduced Dia. Seals 2 - DT06-2S DT04-2P DT06-2S-C015 DT04-2P-C015 3 - DT06-3S DT04-3P DT06-3S-C015 DT04-3P-C015 4 - DT06-4S DT04-4P DT06-4S-C015 DT04-4P-C015 6 - DT06-6S DT04-6P DT06-6S-C015 DT04-6P-C015 Key A DT06-08SA DT04-08PA DT06-08SA-C015 DT04-08PA-C015 Key B DT06-08SB DT04-08PB DT06-08SB-C015 DT04-08PB-C015 Key C DT06-08SC DT04-08PC DT06-08SC-C015 DT04-08PC-C015 Key D DT06-08SD DT04-08PD DT06-08SD-C015 DT04-08PD-C015 Key A DT06-12SA DT04-12PA DT06-12SA-C015 DT04-12PA-C015 Key B DT06-12SB DT04-12PB DT06-12SB-C015 DT04-12PB-C015 Key C DT06-12SC DT04-12PC DT06-12SC-C015 DT04-12PC-C015 Key D DT06-12SD DT04-12PD DT06-12SD-C015 DT04-12PD-C015 Position 8 12 PAGE 115 DT Family DTM SERIES ORDERING INFORMATION Here are some of the common part numbers in the DTM series. Several additional connectors may be available. Position Keying Plug Receptacle 2 - DTM06-2S DTM04-2P 3 - DTM06-3S DTM04-3P 4 - DTM06-4S DTM04-4P 6 - DTM06-6S DTM04-6P Key A DTM06-08SA DTM04-08PA Key B DTM06-08SB DTM04-08PB Key C DTM06-08SC DTM04-08PC Key D DTM06-08SD DTM04-08PD Key A DTM06-12SA DTM04-12PA Key B DTM06-12SB DTM04-12PB Key C DTM06-12SC DTM04-12PC Key D DTM06-12SD DTM04-12PD 8 12 DTP SERIES ORDERING INFORMATION Here are some of the common part numbers in the DTP series. Several additional connectors may be available. Plug Receptacle Plug Reduced Dia. Seals Receptacle Reduced Dia. Seals 2 DTP06-2S DTP04-2P DTP06-2S-C015 DTP04-2P-C015 4 DTP06-4S DTP04-4P DTP06-4S-C015 DTP04-4P-C015 Position WIRE SEALING RANGE The wire sealing range is the recommended outside diameter of the wire insulation required to maintain an environmental seal in the rear connector cavities. Contact Size Standard Seal Extra Thin Seal E-Seal 20 14-22 AWG (2.5-0.35mm2) .053-.120 (1.35-3.05) - 16 14-20 AWG (2.0-0.5mm2) .088-.145 (2.23-3.68) .053-.120 (1.35-3.05) 12 10-14 AWG (6.0-2.0mm2) .134-.170 (3.40-4.32) .097-.158 (2.46-4.01) INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DT Family Required Components SECONDARY WEDGELOCKS DEUTSCH DT style electrical connectors require secondary wedgelocks which are sold separately. The wedgelocks help confirm proper contact alignment within each connector. Secondary wedgelocks are assembled at the mating interface and press into place. If by chance the secondary wedgelocks are not properly seated during assembly, they will be pressed into locked position during the mating of the connector. Adding to the design flexibility of the DT series, several wedgelocks offer keying options. Wedgelocks for enhanced seal retention plugs (P012) are also available. DT Series Receptacle Wedgelocks DT Series Plug Wedgelocks W2P* Wedgelock for 2 way receptacle *A, B, C, D keying available W2S* Wedgelock for 2 way plug *A, B, C, D keying available W3P* Wedgelock for 3 way receptacle *J1939 keying available W3S* Wedgelock for 3 way plug *J1939 keying available W4P* Wedgelock for 4 way receptacle *A, B, C, D keying available W4S* Wedgelock for 4 way plug *A, B, C, D keying available W6P Wedgelock for 6 way receptacle W6S Wedgelock for 6 way plug W8P Wedgelock for 8 way receptacle W8S Wedgelock for 8 way plug W12P Wedgelock for 12 way receptacle W12S Wedgelock for 12 way plug Note Wedgelocks for enhanced plugs (P012) are available. PAGE 117 DT Family DTM Series Receptacle Wedgelocks DTM Series Plug Wedgelocks WM-2P* Wedgelock for 2 way receptacle *A, B, C, D keying available WM-2S* Wedgelock for 2 way plug *A, B, C, D keying available WM-3P Wedgelock for 3 way receptacle WM-3S Wedgelock for 3 way plug WM-4P Wedgelock for 4 way receptacle WM-4S Wedgelock for 4 way plug WM-6P Wedgelock for 6 way receptacle WM-6S Wedgelock for 6 way plug WM-8P Wedgelock for 8 way receptacle WM-8S Wedgelock for 8 way plug WM-12P Wedgelock for 12 way receptacle WM-12S Wedgelock for 12 way plug DTP Series Receptacle Wedgelocks DTP Series Plug Wedgelocks WP-2P Wedgelock for 2 way receptacle WP-2S Wedgelock for 2 way plug WP-4P Wedgelock for 4 way receptacle WP-4S Wedgelock for 4 way plug Special Modifications The DT series connectors offer several modifications to enhance the design flexibility and meet application specific needs. Options include enhanced seal retention, flanges, and connector body color just to mention a few. By combining the DT series connectors with the available modifications and accessories, the design possibilities are immense. B016 MODIFICATION The B016 receptacle modification helps prevent mis-mating. The B016 is available for the DT 12 way connectors, DT13/15, and DTF13/15 PCB series connectors. In addition to the four keying positions (A, B, C, or D) and color coding, the B016 enhancement gives the user both visual and tactile proof of correct mating, thus helping eliminate mis-mating opportunities during assembly. Please note the P012 plug is the required mate for the B016 receptacle to make the enhancement effective. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DT Family DETECTOR The Detector connector has an integrated LED used for diagnostics. The transparent housing features reduced diameter seals and may be ordered with or without an end cap. Color coded wedgelocks for operating voltages, 12VDC and 24VDC are available. Description Part Number Plug, 2 way, LED, transparent Ultem material, reduced diameter seals, end cap DT06-2S-SDT-CE27 Plug, 2 way, LED, transparent Ultem material, reduced diameter seals DT06-2S-SDT-CE28 Wedgelock, LED, 12V, yellow W2S-SDT-12V Wedgelock, LED, 24V, red W2S-SDT-24V P012 MODIFICATION The DT P012 plugs provide enhanced front seal retention resulting in an ultra tight environmental seal. The enhanced seal retention keeps the seal in place during mating and unmating. The P012 modification requires an enhanced P012 wedgelock. The DEUTSCH P012 modification is available in 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, and 12 cavity arrangements. P012 plugs have a black connector body except for the 8 and 12 cavity arrangements, where the color is based on the key. C015 MODIFICATION The C015 modification offers a reduced diameter insert cavity allowing for a proper seal with smaller wire insulation. The C015 modification is also referred to as an “E” seal. E003 MODIFICATION The E003 modification offers a protective end cap attached to the rear of the connector. There are holes in the cap to allow the contacts to be inserted. PAGE 119 DT Family E004 MODIFICATION The E004 modification changes the connector body color to black. E005 MODIFICATION The E005 modification offers a protective end cap attached to the rear of the connector and has a black connector body. E007 & E008 MODIFICATION To meet the application requirements where wires need added protection, the DT (E008) and DTM (E007) series may be supplied with shrink boot adapters. These adapters accept shrink tubing. FLANGE MODIFICATIONS Designed to simplify wire routing and assembly, DT series receptacles are available in many mounting configurations and styles. Welded flange • Welded flange - BL04, BL08, CL03, L012, LE14 • Welded flange, end cap - LE07, LE11 • Welded flange, shrink boot adapter - LE08, LE12 Sealed flange • Sealed flange, end cap - CL09, LE01, LE05, LE06, LE09, LE10, LE17, LE21 • Sealed flange, shrink boot adapter - BL10, CL07 Note Additional modifications are available, please contact your representative. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DT Family Accessories Several accessory items are available to complement the connectors including boots, backshells, gaskets, dust caps, and mounting clips. Accessory items cover a wide array of design requirements such as assisting with mounting, providing additional protection, and offering enhanced aesthetics. ut LAD D l u si v e t ion xc o E GASKETS D i s t ri b Moisture, dirt, salt, sand, and road debris can all work their way into electrical panels through unsealed mounting flanges. Rated to operate in environments from -70°F to +225°F (-56°C to +107°C), these rugged high quality neoprene gaskets form a tight seal between the panel face and connector flange to help keep out destructive elements. The gaskets have a thickness of .125” and the material meets the UL-94-HBF, Mil-R-6130C, and FMVSS-302 flammability specifications. Gasket Part Number Connector Part Number DT3P-L012-GKT DT04-3P-L012 DT4P-L012-GKT DT04-4P-L012 DTP4P-L012-GKT DTP04-4P-L012 DT8P-L012-GKT DT04-08P*-L012 DT12-L012-GKT DT04-12P*-L012 DTM04-12P*-L012 ut LAD D l u si v e t ion xc o E DUST CAPS D i s t ri b The DT series dust caps are made of either thermoplastic or durable plastisol and are designed to provide protection for the connector interface when the two halves are not mated. The plastisol caps, available for plugs and receptacles, are suitable for providing temporary protection from dirt, dust, and paint overspray. The thermoplastic caps provide an environmental seal for an unmated plug. Thermoplastic Dust Cap Part Number Connector Part Number 1011-344-0205 DT06-2S 1011-345-0305 DT06-3S 1011-346-0405 DT06-4S 1011-347-0605 DT06-6S 1011-348-0805 DT06-08S* 1011-349-1205 DT06-12S*, DT16-15S*, DT16-18S* PAGE 121 DT Family Plastisol Dust Cap Part Number Connector Part Number DTM3S-DC DTM06-3S DT3P-DC DT04-3P DT4P-DC DT04-4P DT6P-DC DT04-6P DTM12P-DC DTM04-12P* DT12P-DC, DT12P-DC-BK DT04-12P* DT12S-DC DT06-12S* ut LAD D l u si v e t ion xc o E BOOTS D i s t ri b Boots provide a professional looking finishing touch for DEUTSCH DT family connectors. Made of durable plastisol, these slip-on boots are not only aesthetically appealing, but also provide increased protection from dirt, paint overspray, and pressure washing. The plastisol boots are rated from -20°F to +212°F (-28°C to +100°C) and offer a slip-on design making installation quick and easy. Boot Part Number Receptacle Boot Description DT Series DTM Series DTP Series 2 way receptacle boot, gray DT2P-BT DTM2P-BT DTP2P-BT 2 way receptacle boot, black DT2P-BT-BK DTM2P-BT-BK DTP2P-BT-BK 3 way receptacle boot, gray DT3P-BT DTM3P-BT - 3 way receptacle boot, black DT3P-BT-BK DTM3P-BT-BK - 4 way receptacle boot, gray DT4P-BT DTM4P-BT DTP4P-BT 4 way receptacle boot, gray, enhanced length - - DTP4P-BT-EN 6 way receptacle boot, gray DT6P-BT DTM6P-BT - 6 way receptacle boot, black DT6P-BT-BK - - 8 way receptacle boot, gray DT8P-BT DTM8P-BT - 8 way receptacle boot, black DT8P-BT-BK DTM8P-BT-BK - 12 way receptacle boot, gray DT12P-BT DTM12P-BT - 12 way receptacle boot, black DT12P-BT-BK DTM12P-BT-BK - 12 way receptacle boot, gray, enhanced length DT12P-BT-EN - - *Distorting the boots can lessen their longevity INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DT Family Boot Part Number Plug Boot Description DT Series DTM Series DTP Series 2 way plug boot, gray DT2S-BT DTM2S-BT DTP2S-BT 2 way plug boot, black DT2S-BT-BK DTM2S-BT-BK - 3 way plug boot, gray DT3S-BT DTM3S-BT - 3 way plug boot, black DT3S-BT-BK DTM3S-BT-BK - 4 way plug boot, gray DT4S-BT DTM4S-BT DTP4S-BT - - DTP4S-BT-EN 6 way plug boot, gray DT6S-BT DTM6S-BT - 6 way plug boot, black DT6S-BT-BK - - 8 way plug boot, gray DT8S-BT DTM8S-BT - 8 way plug boot, black DT8S-BT-BK DTM8S-BT-BK - 12 way plug boot, gray DT12S-BT DTM12S-BT - 12 way plug boot, black DT12S-BT-BK DTM12S-BT-BK - 12 way plug boot, gray, enhanced length DT12S-BT-EN - - DT48S-BT - - 4 way plug boot, gray, enhanced length 48 way plug boot, gray *Distorting the boots can lessen their longevity PAGE 123 DT Family BACKSHELLS The DEUTSCH DT and DTM series backshells are designed to snap onto and mate with all standard (basic plug and receptacles without modifications that affect the rear of the connector) DT and DTM series connectors. The rigid, durable backshells offer a high level of protection and allow convoluted tubing to nest within the rear of the backshell. Straight (180°) and right angle (90°) versions and backshells with strain relief for jacketed cable are also available. Since the backshells are designed to work with the standard DT and DTM connectors, tests should be conducted for fit and function of a backshell being used on any part with a modification. DT Series Receptacle Backshells Connector Style DT04-2P 180° Strain Relief Tubing size (mm) Part Number 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-229-0205 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-257-0205 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-230-0205 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-258-0205 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-233-0305 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-261-0305 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-234-0305 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-262-0305 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-237-0405 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-265-0405 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-238-0405 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-266-0405 8.5, 10, and 13 1011-241-0605 8.5, 10, and 13 1011-269-0605 8.5, 10, and 13 1011-242-0605 8.5, 10, and 13 1011-270-0605 180° 8.5, 10, and 13 1011-245-0805 90° 8.5, 10, and 13 1011-246-0805 180° 10, 13, and 17 1011-249-1205 90° 10, 13, and 17 1011-250-1205 180° X 90° 90° DT04-3P X 180° 180° X 90° 90° DT04-4P X 180° 180° X 90° 90° DT04-6P X 180° 180° X 90° 90° DT04-08P* DT04-12P* X INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DT Family DT Series Plug Backshells Connector Style DT06-2S 180° Strain Relief Tubing size (mm) Part Number 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-227-0205 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-255-0205 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-228-0205 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-256-0205 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-231-0305 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-259-0305 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-232-0305 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-260-0305 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-235-0405 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-263-0405 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-236-0405 6, 7.5, 8.5, and 10 1011-264-0405 8.5, 10, and 13 1011-239-0605 8.5, 10, and 13 1011-267-0605 8.5, 10, and 13 1011-240-0605 8.5, 10, and 13 1011-268-0605 180° 8.5, 10, and 13 1011-243-0805 90° 8.5, 10, and 13 1011-244-0805 180° 10, 13, and 17 1011-247-1205 90° 10, 13, and 17 1011-248-1205 180° 13 and 17 1028-043-1205 180° X 90° 90° DT06-3S X 180° 180° X 90° 90° DT06-4S X 180° 180° X 90° 90° DT06-6S X 180° 180° X 90° 90° DT06-08S* DT06-12S* DT06-12S*-**** X Note: 1028-043-1205 backshell is designed to fit on 12 way plugs with modifications PULL OFF STRENGTH Connector Fp [N] FT [N] DT04-2P / DT06-2S 50 / 50 50 / 10 DT04-3P / DT06-3S 50 / 50 50 / 50 DT04-4P / DT06-4S 50 / 50 50 / 25 DT04-6P / DT06-6S 50 / 50 50 / 30 DT04-08P* / DT06-08S* 50 / 50 50 / 35 DT04-12P* / DT06-12S* 50 / 50 50 / 40 FT FT 90° 90° FP FP PAGE 125 DT Family DTM Series Backshells Connector Style Tubing size (mm) Part Number DTM*04-2P 180° 7.5 and 8.5 1028-021-0205 DTM06-2S 180° 7.5 and 8.5 1011-273-0205 DTM*06-2S 180° 8.5 1028-041-0205 DTM*04-3P 180° 8.5 1028-024-0305 DTM*06-3S 180° 8.5 1028-005-0305 DTM*04-4P 180° 8.5 1028-027-0405 DTM*06-4S 180° 8.5 1028-008-0405 DTM06-6S 180° 10 and 13 1028-011-0605 DTM06-08S* 180° 10 and 13 1028-013-0805 DTM04-12P* 180° 13 and 17 1028-034-1205 DTM06-12S* 180° 13 and 17 1028-015-1205 Adapter for 2, 3, and 4 pin 90° 7.5 and 8.5 1028-016-0005 Adapter for 6 and 8 pin 90° 10 and 13 1028-017-0005 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DT Family MOUNTING CLIPS Mounting clips are installed on the receptacle to mount DT series connectors. To meet design needs, the clips are available for several configurations and in plastic, stainless steel, or steel with zinc plating. Cavity Arrangement Mounting Direction Color/Material Hole O.D. inches (mm) 1027-003-1200 DT 2, 3, 4, 6, 12 DTM, DTP (all) Straight Stainless steel .433 (11.0) 1027-005-1200 DT 2, 3, 4, 6, 12 DTM, DTP (all) Straight Stainless steel .512 (13.0) 1027-004-1200 DT 2, 3, 4, 6, 12 DTM, DTP (all) Straight Steel w/ zinc plating .512 (13.0) 1027-008-1200 DT 2, 3, 4, 6, 12 DTM, DTP (all) Side Steel w/ zinc plating .433 (11.0) 1027-013-1200/ 1027-017-1200 DT 2, 3, 4, 6, 12 DTM, DTP (all) Side Steel w/ zinc plating .323 (8.2) 1027-001-0800 DT 8 cavity only Straight Stainless steel .433 (11.0) 1027-006-0800 DT 8 cavity only Straight Stainless steel .512 (13.0) 1027-002-0800 DT 8 cavity only Straight Steel w/ zinc plating .512 (13.0) 1027-014-0800 DT 8 cavity only Straight Steel w/ zinc plating .323 (8.2) 1011-026-0205 DT 2, 3, 4, 6, 12 DTM, DTP (all) Straight Gray plastic .200 (5.08) 1011-030-0205 DT 2, 3, 4, 6, 12 DTM, DTP (all) Straight Black plastic --- *Connector removeable with 50N of force DT 2, 3, 4, 6, 12 DTM, DTP (all) Straight Black plastic --- 1011-027-0805 DT 8 cavity only Straight Gray plastic .200 (5.08) Part Number 1011-310-0205* PAGE 127 DT Family DT Family Printed Circuit Board Connectors The DT Family offers printed circuit board (PCB) connectors that are heavy duty environmentally sealed connectors designed for wire-to-circuit board connections. Available in a variety of styles for the DT, DTM, and DTP connector series, DEUTSCH PCB connectors cover a range of pin counts from 2 to 48 and wire gauges from 10 to 22. Many of the connectors are available in straight or 90° pin options. PCB PART NUMBERING SYSTEM Part Number DT* 13 - 6 P * - **** Series Special Modifications Blank DT series Key (if applicable) F DTF series M DTM series MF P A B C D Contacts DTMF series P DTP series Pin Configuration Style 13 Receptacle, 90° pins 15 Receptacle, straight pins Note For additional information, please see the PCB section. DT FAMILY PCB CONFIGURATIONS Pin/Flange Style 90° Flange Straight Flange 90° Flangeless Straight Flangeless 2 way receptacle, DT series DT13-2P DT15-2P DTF13-2P - 3 way receptacle, DT series - - DTF13-3P - 4 way receptacle, DT series DT13-4P DT15-4P DTF13-4P - DTP13-4P DTP15-4P - - 6 way receptacle, DT series DT13-6P DT15-6P DTF13-6P - 8 way receptacle, DT series DT13-08P* DT15-08P* - - 12 way receptacle, DT series DT13-12P* DT15-12P* DTF13-12P* DTF15-12P* 12 way receptacle, DTM series DTM13-12P* DTM15-12P* - - 48 way receptacle, DTM series - - - DTMF15-48P Connector Description 4 way receptacle, DTP series * = Keying (A, B, C, or D) INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DT Family DTMH Series & High Temperature Modification Overview The DTMH series and DTM series EE04 modification connectors are environmentally sealed, high temperature connectors capable of operating in temperatures -55°C to +150°C. They accept size 20 contacts and carry 7.5 amps each. The DTMH connectors are available in 2-4 cavity arrangements and feature an integrated TPA for easy assembly. The EE04 connectors are available in 6, 8, and 12 cavity arrangements and require a secondary wedgelock. DTMH SERIES PART NUMBERING SYSTEM Part Number DTMH 04 - 2 P * Key (if applicable) Series Style A 04 Receptacle 06 Plug B C D Contacts Configuration P Pin S Socket DTMH SERIES CONFIGURATIONS DTMH0*-2** 2 size 20 DTMH0*-3** 3 size 20 DTMH0*-4** 4 size 20 DTMH SERIES DIMENSIONS B E A D C F DTMH Plug DTMH Receptacle Overall Length A Overall Height B Overall Width C Overall Length D Overall Height E Overall Width F 2 1.085 (27.56) .508 (12.90) .555 (14.10) 1.620 (41.15) .638 (16.21) .729 (18.52) 3 1.085 (27.56) .558 (14.17) .640 (16.26) 1.620 (41.16) .638 (16.21) .894 (22.71) 4 1.185 (30.10) .652 (16.56) .680 (17.27) 1.720 (43.69) .772 (19.61) .834 (21.18) Cavity Dimensions are for reference only. PAGE 129 DT Family DTM SERIES (EE04 MOD) PART NUMBERING SYSTEM Part Number DTM 06 - 6 S * - EE04 Series High Temperature Black Modification Style 04 Receptacle 06 Plug Key (if applicable) A 8 C D Contacts Configuration 6 B 12 P Pin S Socket DTM SERIES CONFIGURATIONS Note DTM EE04 connectors require a secondary wedgelock DTM0*-6*-EE04 6 size 20 DTM0*-08**-EE04 8 size 20 DTM0*-12**-EE04 12 size 20 A, B, C, D A, B, C, D that is sold separately. DTM SERIES DIMENSIONS E B C A F DTM Plug D DTM Receptacle Overall Length A Overall Height B Overall Width C Overall Length D Overall Height E Overall Width F 6 1.185 (30.10) .817 (20.75) .600 (15.24) 1.720 (43.69) .937 (23.80) .756 (19.20) 8 1.185 (30.10) .600 (15.24) 1.245 (31.62) 1.720 (43.69) .792 (20.12) 1.245 (31.62) 12 1.185 (30.10) .600 (15.24) 1.575 (40.01) 1.720 (43.69) .796 (20.22) 1.575 (40.01) Cavity Dimensions are for reference only. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DT Family DTV Series Overview The DEUTSCH DTV series connectors offer the same time tested reliability and performance as the DT series, with the added flexibility of an 18 cavity flanged design. DTV SERIES PART NUMBERING SYSTEM Part Number DTV 06 - 18 S * Key (if applicable) Series Style A 02 Receptacle 06 Plug B C D Contacts Configuration P Pin S Socket DTV SERIES DIMENSIONS E B C A DTV Plug Cavity 18 D F DTV Receptacle Overall Length A Overall Height B Overall Width C Overall Length D Overall Height E Overall Width F 1.405 (35.69) 1.059 (26.90) 1.450 (36.83) 2.495 (63.37) 1.786 (45.36) 3.194 (81.12) Dimensions are for reference only. SECONDARY WEDGELOCKS DTV Series Receptacle Wedgelock DTV Series Plug Wedgelock WV-18P WV-18S Wedgelock for 18 way receptacle Wedgelock for 18 way plug PAGE 131 DT Family How To Instructions CONTACT INSERTION Step 1: Grasp crimped contact approximately one inch behind the contact barrel. Step 2: Hold connector with rear grommet facing you. Step 3: Push contact straight into connector grommet until a click is felt. A slight tug will confirm that it is properly locked in place. Note The receptacle is shown, use the same procedure for the plug. Step 4: Once all contacts are in place, insert green wedge. The green wedge will snap into place. CONTACT REMOVAL Step 1: Remove green wedge using needlenose pliers to pull wedge straight out. Step 2: To remove the contacts, gently pull wire backwards, while at the same time releasing the locking finger by moving it away from the contact with a screwdriver. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Step 3: Hold the rear seal in place, as removing the contact will displace the seal. Contents HD10 Series Overview...........................................134 Performance Specifications.................................134 Material Specifications...........................................134 Dimensions................................................................. 135 Configurations...........................................................136 Ordering Information.............................................. 137 Special Modifications.............................................. 138 Accessories.........................................................139-142 How To Instructions................................................143 HD10 Series HD10 Series Overview The HD10 series is an environmentally sealed, thermoplastic, and cylindrical connector series. With arrangements from 3 to 9 cavities, HD10 connectors accept size 4, 12, or 16 contacts and are available either in-line or flanged. HD10 connectors are heavily used for diagnostic applications and are available with or without a coupling ring. DEUTSCH CONNECTOR PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Temperature: Operating at temperatures -55°C to +125°C Durability: No electrical or mechanical defects after 100 cycles of engagement and disengagement. Vibration: No unlocking or unmating and exhibits no mechanical or physical damage after sinusoidal vibration levels of 20 G’s at 10 to 2000 Hz in each of the three mutually perpendicular planes. No electrical discontinuities longer than 1 microsecond. Fluid Resistance: Connectors show no damage when exposed to most fluids used in industrial applications. Insulation Resistance: 1000 megohms minimum at 25°C. Immersion: IP68 rating Moisture Resistance: Properly wired and mated connections will withstand immersion under three feet of water without loss of electronic qualities or leakage. Dielectric Withstanding Voltage: Current leakage less than 2 milliamps at 1500 volts AC. Thermal Cycle: No cracking, chipping or leaking after 20 test cycles from -55°C to +125°C. MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS Grommet: Silicone rubber Insert Retainer: Thermoplastic Receptacle Interfacial Seal: Silicone rubber Shell: Thermoplastic INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS HD10 Series DIMENSIONS A C ØB ØD HD10 Plug HD10 Receptacle Overall Length A Overall Height ØB Overall Length C Overall Height ØD 3 1.609 (40.87) 1.069 (27.15) 1.639 (41.63) .851 (21.62) 4 1.639 (41.63) 1.595 (40.51) 1.639 (41.63) 1.281 (32.54) 5 1.609 (40.87) 1.218 (30.94) 1.639 (41.63) 1.001 (25.43) 6 1.619 (41.12) 1.453 (36.91) 1.639 (41.63) 1.141 (28.98) 9 1.609 (40.87) 1.593 (40.47) 1.639 (41.63) 1.281 (32.54) Cavity Dimensions are for reference only. CONNECTOR STYLES Plug HD16 Square Flange Receptacle HD10 In-line Receptacle HD14 PAGE 135 HD10 Series CONFIGURATIONS Insert Arrangement XX-XX X size XX 3-16/3-96* 3 size 16 4-4 1 size 4 3 size 16 5-16 5 size 16 6-12 6 size 12 Configuration Number and Size of Cavities 6-96 6 size 16 9-16 9 size 16 9-96* 9 size 16 *Also available in an “E” seal PART NUMBERING SYSTEM Part Number HD 10 - 9 - 96 P * - **** Series Special Modifications Style Wire Seals 10 Square Flange Receptacle 14 In-line Receptacle 16 Plug Configuration Threaded Rear 4 4 Configuration 12 No Coupling Ring on Plug, 6 Configuration 96 3, 6, or 9 Configurations Non-Threaded Rear 16 3, 5, or 9 Configurations INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Blank Standard Seal E Extra Thin Wall Seal Contacts P Pin S Socket HD10 Series ORDERING INFORMATION Here are some of the common part numbers in the HD10 series. Several additional connectors may be available. Position Contact Size Rear Threads Plug Receptacle Inline Receptacle Flange no HD16-3-16S HD14-3-16P - yes HD16-3-96S HD14-3-96P HD10-3-96P 3 16 4 4/16 yes HD16-4-4S - HD10-4-4P 5 16 no HD16-5-16S HD14-5-16P HD10-5-16P 6 16 yes HD16-6-96S HD14-6-96P HD10-6-96P 6 12 yes HD16-6-12S-B010 HD14-6-12P HD10-6-12P 9 16 no HD16-9-16S HD14-9-16P HD10-9-16P yes HD16-9-96S HD14-9-96P HD10-9-96P 9 (1939) 16 yes HD16-9-1939S HD14-9-1939P HD10-9-1939P WIRE SEALING RANGE The wire sealing range is the recommended outside diameter of the wire insulation required to maintain an environmental seal in the rear connector cavities. Standard Seal Extra Thin Seal E-Seal 16 14-20 AWG (2.0-0.5mm2) .100-.150 (2.54-3.81) .053-.120 (1.35-3.05) 12 10-14 AWG (5.0-2.0mm2) .134-.170 (3.40-4.32) - .280-.292 (7.11-7.42) - Contact Size 4 6 AWG (13.0mm2) PAGE 137 HD10 Series Special Modifications HD10 series connectors offer several modifications to enhance the design flexibility and meet application specific needs. Options include the addition of a coupling ring and connector body color, just to mention a few. By combining the HD10 series connectors with the available modifications and accessories, the design possibilities are increased. B010 MODIFICATION The B010 modification provides the addition of a coupling ring used for mating. The B010 modification is only available on the HD16-6-12S-B010 connector. E004 MODIFICATION The E004 modification changes the HD10 series connector from the standard gray to a black connector body. J1939 MODIFICATIONS (BP03, P080) The P080 modification changes the HD10 series connector body color from the standard gray to green and meets the J1939 Type II requirements. The BP03 modification is similar to the P080 modification, but features a panel mount. N005 MODIFICATION The N005 modification is an HD10 series receptacle with molded-in, straight PCB pins. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS HD10 Series Accessories Several accessory items are available to complement HD10 series connectors including boots, backshells, gaskets, and protective caps. Accessory items cover a wide array of design requirements such as assisting with mounting, providing additional protection, and offering enhanced aesthetics. ut LAD D l u si v e t ion xc o E BACKSHELLS DEUTSCH HD10 series backshells are designed to screw onto all threaded HD10 connectors. Rated for temperatures from -40°C to +134°C, the rigid, durable backshells offer a high level of protection, provide strain relief, and improve aesthetics. D i s t ri b Connector Part Number Cable Diameter Backshell Part Number Compression Nut Part Number HD1*-3-96* .187-.300 M902-2131 M902-2041 .300-.430 M902-2132 M902-2042 .187-.300 M902-2161 M902-2041 .300-.430 M902-2162 M902-2042 .430-.570 M902-2163 M902-2053 .570-.710 M902-2164 M902-2054 .187-.300 M902-2191 M902-2041 .300-.430 M902-2192 M902-2042 .430-.570 M902-2193 M902-2053 .570-.710 M902-2194 M902-2054 HD1*-6-96*/HD1*-6-12* HD1*-9-96*/HD1*-9-1939** Backshell Technical Specifications: Material - PC/PET Polyester Blend, UV-Stabilized, Flame Retardant, Black Flammability - UL94-VO rated material, Weatherability - UL746C PAGE 139 HD10 Series STRAIN RELIEF DEUTSCH HD10 series strain reliefs are designed to screw onto threaded 3, 4, 6, and 9 cavity HD10 connectors. The rigid, durable strain reliefs offer a high level of protection, provide tie wrap holders to reduce strain from the wires, and improve aesthetics. Part Number Description HD18-003 3 cavity strain relief HD18-006 6 cavity strain relief HD18-009 4 or 9 cavity strain relief helpful hint Attaching the connector to a structure eliminates straining the electrical system in service. ut LAD D l u si v e t ion xc o E BOOTS D i s t ri b Boots provide a professional looking finishing touch for DEUTSCH HD10 series connectors. Made of durable plastisol, these slip-on boots are not only aesthetically appealing, but also provide increased protection from dirt, paint overspray, and pressure washing. The plastisol boots are rated from -20°F to +212°F (-28°C to + 100°C) and offer a slip-on design making installation quick and easy. Part Number Description HD10-3BT 3 cavity boot, gray HD10-5BT 5 cavity boot, gray HD10-5BT-BK 5 cavity boot, black HD10-6BT 6 cavity boot, gray HD10-6BT-BK 6 cavity boot, black HD10-9BT 9 cavity boot, gray HD10-9BT-BK 9 cavity boot, black *Distorting the boots can lessen their longevity INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS HD10 Series ut LAD D l u si v e t ion xc o E GASKETS D i s t ri b Moisture, dirt, salt, sand, and road debris can all work their way into electrical panels through unsealed mounting flanges. Rated to operate in environments from -70°F to +225°F (-56°C to +107°C), these rugged high quality neoprene gaskets form a tight seal between the panel face and connector flange to help keep out destructive elements. The gaskets have a thickness of .125” and the material meets the UL-94-HBF, Mil-R-6130C, and FMVSS-302 flammability specifications. Gasket Part Number Connector Part Number HD10-3-GKT HD10-3-**** HD10-5-GKT HD10-5-**** HD10-6-GKT HD10-6-**** HD10-9-GKT HD10-9-**** PROTECTIVE DUST CAPS HD10 series protective dust caps provide an environmental seal and are used to protect the connector interface when the connector is not mated. Part Number Description HDC14-3 3 cavity plug protective cap HDC14-6 6 cavity plug protective cap HDC14-9 9 cavity plug protective cap HDC16-3 3 cavity receptacle protective cap HDC16-5 5 cavity receptacle protective cap HDC16-6 6 cavity receptacle protective cap HDC16-6-E004 6 cavity receptacle protective cap, black HDC16-9 9 cavity receptacle protective cap HDC16-9-E004 9 cavity receptacle protective cap, black PAGE 141 HD10 Series Lanyards are available in nitrile or nylon coated steel and designed for use with protective dust caps. ut LAD D l u si v e t ion xc o E LANYARDS D i s t ri b HDC9-JDL082397 (DEUTSCH HDC16-9-E004 dust cap assembled with JDL082397) HDC16-9-L47N (DEUTSCH HDC16-9 dust cap assembled with L47N-600-1) Material Material Diameter Length Min. Breaking Strength JDL082397 Nitrile o-ring, 3M heat shrink with thermoplastic adhesive .07 inches 5.31 inches --- L47N-600-1 7 x 7 galvanized steel cable coated with clear nylon .047 inches 6 inches 270 lbs. Used On Connector Cavities Lanyard Material Dust Cap Color HDC14-3-JDL Plug 3 Nitrile Gray HDC14-6-JDL Plug 6 Nitrile Gray HDC14-6-LA Plug 6 Steel Gray HDC14-9-JDL Plug 9 Nitrile Gray HDC16-3-JDL Receptacle 3 Nitrile Gray HDC16-3-LA Receptacle 3 Steel Gray HDC16-5-LA Receptacle 5 Steel Gray HDC16-6-JDL Receptacle 6 Nitrile Gray HDC16-6-LA Receptacle 6 Steel Gray HDC16-9-JDL Receptacle 9 Nitrile Gray HDC9-JDL082397 Receptacle 9 Nitrile Black HDC16-9-L47N Receptacle 9 Steel Gray HDC16-9-E004-L47N Receptacle 9 Steel Black Lanyard Dimensions are for reference only. Dust Cap/Lanyard Assembly Part Number* *Other dust cap/lanyard assemblies may be available INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS HD10 Series How To Instructions CONTACT INSERTION Step 1: Grasp crimped contact approximately one inch behind the contact barrel. Step 2: Hold connector with rear grommet facing you. Step 3: Push contact straight into connector grommet until a click is felt. A slight tug will confirm that it is properly locked in place. Step 2: Slide tool along the wire into the insert cavity until it engages contact and resistance is felt. Step 3: Pull contact wire assembly out of connector. CONTACT REMOVAL Step 1: With rear insert toward you, snap appropriate size removal tool over the wire of contact to be removed. PAGE 143 HD10 Series NOTES: INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Contents HD30 & HDP20 Series Overview.......................145 Performance Specifications.................................146 Material Specifications........................................... 147 Dimensions................................................................. 147 Configurations.................................................. 148-149 Ordering Information.......................................150-151 Special Modifications......................................153-154 Accessories.........................................................154-158 Mounting.............................................................158-159 How To Instructions....................................... 159-160 HD30 & HDP20 Series HD30 & HDP20 Series Overview Designed specifically for the truck, bus, and off-highway industry, the HD30 & HDP20 series connectors are heavy duty, environmentally sealed, multi-pin circular connectors. Available in metal or thermoplastic housings, these connectors offer multiple pin configurations that accept contact sizes 4 through 20. HD30 SERIES OVERVIEW The DEUTSCH HD30 series connectors are constructed from a metal shell developed to meet the needs of the heavy duty equipment and transportation industries. The HD30 features include quick connectdisconnect bayonet coupling, single hole bulkhead mounting, silicone seals, and a rear insertion/rear removal contact system. HDP20 SERIES OVERVIEW The HDP20 series connectors are heavy duty rated, environmentally sealed, composite shell, multi-pin connectors. The composite thermoplastic shell is suited for applications where chemicals can damage a connector housing. HDP20 features quick connect-disconnect bayonet coupling, single hole bulkhead mounting, silicone seals, and a rear insertion/rear removal contact system. DEUTSCH CONNECTOR PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Temperature: Operating at temperatures -55°C to +125°C Durability: No electrical or mechanical defects after 100 cycles of engagement and disengagement. Vibration: No unlocking or unmating and exhibits no mechanical or physical damage after sinusoidal vibration levels of 20 G’s at 10 to 2000 Hz in each of the three mutually perpendicular planes. No electrical discontinuities longer than 1 microsecond. Fluid Resistance: Connectors show no damage when exposed to most fluids used in industrial applications. Insulation Resistance: 1000 megohms minimum at 25°C. Immersion: IP68 rating Moisture Resistance: Properly wired and mated connections will withstand immersion under three feet of water without loss of electronic qualities or leakage. Dielectric Withstanding Voltage: Current leakage less than 2 milliamps at 1500 volts AC. Thermal Cycle: No cracking, chipping or leaking after 20 test cycles from -55°C to +125°C. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS HD30 & HDP20 Series MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS HD30 Series Grommet: HDP20 Series Grommet: Silicone rubber Silicone rubber Insert Retainer: Unfilled PEI Insert Retainer: Unfilled PEI Plug Coupling Aluminum Ring: Plug Coupling Glass filled PA Ring: Shell: Shell: Aluminum Glass filled PA DIMENSIONS ØB A HD/HDP Plug ØD C HD/HDP Receptacle Overall Length A Overall Height ØB Overall Length C Overall Height ØD 18 1.521 (38.63) 1.700 (43.17) 1.648 (41.86) 1.750 (44.45) 24 1.521 (38.63) 1.950 (49.53) 1.648 (41.86) 2.000 (50.80) Shell Size Dimensions are for reference only. PAGE 147 HD30 & HDP20 Series CONFIGURATIONS Wire Seal Options Insert Arrangement N Normal wire seals (green ring) T Thin wall wire seals (gray ring) E Extra thin wall wire seals (blue ring) XX-XX X size XX X, X, X Shell Size - Configuration Number and Size of Cavities 18 SHELL SIZE CONFIGURATIONS 18-6 2 size 4 & 4 size 16 N, E 18-8 8 size 12 N, E 18-14 14 size 16 N, T, E 18-20 2 size 16 & 18 size 20 N, E 18-21 21 size 20 N 24 SHELL SIZE CONFIGURATIONS 1 24-7(-C038 only) 3 size 4† & 4 size 16 N 24-9 1 size 4, 2 size 8 & 6 size 12 N, E 24-14 1 size 4, 1 size 12 & 12 size 16 N, E 24-16 16 size 12 N, E 24-18 1 size 8, 3 size 12 & 14 size 16 N, E 24-19 6 size 12 & 13 size 16 N, E 24-21 4 size 12 & 17 size 16 N, E 24-23 23 size 16 N, T, E 24-29 4 size 12, 19 size 16 & 6 size 20 E* 24-31 31 size 16 T*, E* †Requires size 4 contact part numbers, 5960-203-04**(pin) and 5962-203-04**(socket) *Modified seal, see drawing. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS HD30 & HDP20 Series 24-33 33 size 20 N 24-35 24-47 3 size 16 & 32 size 20 5 size 16 & 42 size 20 N, E E* 24-91-P064‡ 2 size 8, 2 size 12 & 5 size 16 N, E *Modified seal, see drawing ‡Without P064 modification, plug cavities 4 and 5 are internally connected HD30 SERIES PART NUMBERING SYSTEM Part Number HD* 36 - 24 - 21 S * - *** Series Special Modifications Options B Breakaway plug N Non-environmental Style 4 Receptacle 6 Plug Shell Size 18 24 Configuration 059 Cable Clamp/Adapter 072 Threaded Adapter Wire Seals N Normal Position Wire Seals (green ring) T Thin Wall Wire Seals (gray ring) E Extra Thin Wall Wire Seals (blue ring) Contacts P Pin S Socket Note Reverse arrangements are available as a keying option for the HD30 & HDP20 series connectors. PAGE 149 HD30 & HDP20 Series HDP20 SERIES PART NUMBERING SYSTEM Part Number HDP 26 - 24 - 21 S * - **** Special Modifications Series L015 Threaded Adapter Style 4 Receptacle 6 Plug L017 Ring Adapter L024 Wide Threaded Adapter Wire Seals Shell Size 18 24 Configuration Contacts P Pin S Socket N Normal Position Wire Seals (green ring) T Thin Wall Wire Seals (gray ring) E Extra Thin Wall Wire Seals (blue ring) helpful hint Making the socket contact side the “hot side” can reduce the danger of electric shock. ORDERING INFORMATION Here are some of the common part numbers in the HD30 &HDP20 series. Several additional connectors may be available. Shell SzPosition 18-6 18-8 18-14 18-20 Series Plug Standard Dia. Seal Receptacle Standard Dia. Seal Plug Reduced Dia. Seal Receptacle Reduced Dia. Seal HDP20 HDP26-18-6SN HDP24-18-6PN HDP26-18-6SE HDP24-18-6PE HD30 HD36-18-6SN HD34-18-6PN HD36-18-6SE HD34-18-6PE HDP20 HDP26-18-8SN HDP24-18-8PN HDP26-18-8SE HDP24-18-8PE HD30 HD36-18-8SN HD34-18-8PN HD36-18-8SE HD34-18-8PE HDP20 HDP26-18-14SN HDP24-18-14PN HDP26-18-14SE HDP24-18-14PE HD30 HD36-18-14SN HD34-18-14PN HD36-18-14SE HD34-18-14PE HDP20 HDP26-18-20SN HDP24-18-20PN HDP26-18-20SE HDP24-18-20PE HD30 HD36-18-20SN HD34-18-20PN HD36-18-20SE HD34-18-20PE INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS HD30 & HDP20 Series ORDERING INFORMATION (CONTINUED) Shell SzPosition 18-21 24-7 24-91P064 24-9 24-14 24-16 24-18 24-19 24-21 24-23 24-29 24-31 24-33 24-35 24-47 Series Plug Standard Dia. Seal Receptacle Standard Dia. Seal Plug Reduced Dia. Seal Receptacle Reduced Dia. Seal HDP20 HDP26-18-21SN HDP24-18-21PN HDP26-18-21SE HDP24-18-21PE HD30 HD36-18-21SN HD34-18-21PN HD36-18-21SE HD34-18-21PE HDP20 HDP26-24-7SN HDP24-24-7PN HDP26-24-7SE HDP24-24-7PE HD30 HD36-24-7SN HD34-24-7PN HD36-24-7SE HD34-24-7PE HDP20 HDP26-2491SN-P064 HDP24-2491PN-P064 - - HDP20 HDP26-24-9SN HDP24-24-9PN HDP26-24-9SE HDP24-24-9PE HD30 HD36-24-9SN HD34-24-9PN HD36-24-9SE HD34-24-9PE HDP20 HDP26-24-14SN HDP24-24-14PN HDP26-24-14SE HDP24-24-14PE HD30 HD36-24-14SN HD34-24-14PN HD36-24-14SE HD34-24-14PE HDP20 HDP26-24-16SN HDP24-24-16PN HDP26-24-16SE HDP24-24-16PE HD30 HD36-24-16SN HD34-24-16PN HD36-24-16SE HD34-24-16PE HDP20 HDP26-24-18SN HDP24-24-18PN HDP26-24-18SE HDP24-24-18PE HD30 HD36-24-18SN HD34-24-18PN HD36-24-18SE HD34-24-18PE HDP20 HDP26-24-19SN HDP24-24-19PN HDP26-24-19SE HDP24-24-19PE HD30 HD36-24-19SN HD34-24-19PN HD36-24-19SE HD34-24-19PE HDP20 HDP26-24-21SN HDP24-24-21PN HDP26-24-21SE HDP24-24-21PE HD30 HD36-24-21SN HD34-24-21PN HD36-24-21SE HD34-24-21PE HDP20 HDP26-24-23SN HDP24-24-23PN HDP26-24-23SE HDP24-24-23PE HD30 HD36-24-23SN HD34-24-23PN HD36-24-23SE HD34-24-23PE HDP20 HDP26-24-29SN HDP24-24-29PN HDP26-24-29SE HDP24-24-29PE HD30 HD36-24-29SN HD34-24-29PN HD36-24-29SE HD34-24-29PE HDP20 HDP26-24-31SN HDP24-24-31PN HDP26-24-31SE HDP24-24-31PE HD30 HD36-24-31SN HD34-24-31PN HD36-24-31SE HD34-24-31PE HDP20 HDP26-24-33SN HDP24-24-33PN HDP26-24-33SE HDP24-24-33PE HD30 HD36-24-33SN HD34-24-33PN HD36-24-33SE HD34-24-33PE HDP20 HDP26-24-35SN HDP24-24-35PN HDP26-24-35SE HDP24-24-35PE HD30 HD36-24-35SN HD34-24-35PN HD36-24-35SE HD34-24-35PE HDP20 HDP26-24-47SN HDP24-24-47PN HDP26-24-47SE HDP24-24-47PE HD30 HD36-24-47SN HD34-24-47PN HD36-24-47SE HD34-24-47PE Note Undersize wire insulation is a major cause for leakage. PAGE 151 HD30 & HDP20 Series WIRE SEALING RANGE The wire sealing range is the recommended outside diameter of the wire insulation required to maintain an environmental seal in the rear connector cavities. N-Seal Green Ring T-Seal Gray Ring T-Seal Modified* E-Seal Blue Ring E-Seal Modified* 20 14-22 AWG (2.5-0.35mm2) .040-.095 (1.02-2.41) .040-.095 (1.02-2.41) - .040-.095 (1.02-2.41) .040-.083 (1.01-2.10) 16 14-20 AWG (2.0-0.5mm2) .100-.134 (2.54-3.40) .088-.134 (2.23-3.40) .088-.106 (2.24-2.69) .053-.120 (1.35-3.05) .053-.103 (1.35-2.62) 12 10-14 AWG (6.0-2.0mm2) .134-.170 (3.40-4.32) .113-.170 (2.87-4.32) - .097-.158 (2.46-4.01) .097-.158 (2.46-4.01) 8 8-10 AWG (10.0-5.0mm2) .190-.240 (4.83-6.10) .170-.240 (4.32-6.10) - .135-.220 (3.43-5.59) - 4 6 AWG (16.0-13.0mm2) .280-.292 (7.11-7.42) .261-.292 (6.63-7.42) - .261-.292 (6.63-7.42) - 4 4 AWG (25.0-21.0mm2) .311-.420 (7.90-10.67) - - - - Contact Size *DEUTSCH cavity arrangements 24-29, 24-47, and 24-31 are only available with the modified seals. Arrangement 24-31 Modified E Seal = .053-.106. Please see drawings 0425-016-0000 and 0425-021-0000 for full specifications. Color code is visible from the rear of the receptacle or plug. Green: Normal Seal Gray: Thin Wall Seal Blue: Extra Thin Wall Seal Color Coded Ring helpful hint Proper wire outside diameters help provide water tight seals. Ø INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS HD30 & HDP20 Series Special Modifications The HD30 & HDP20 series connectors offer several modifications to enhance design flexibility and meet application specific needs. Options include breakaway plugs, adapters, and high amperage options just to mention a few. By combining the HD30 & HDP20 series connectors with the available modifications and accessories, the design possibilities are greatly expanded. HDB - BREAKAWAY PLUG (HD30 SERIES ONLY) The HDB breakaway plug is designed to provide an emergency disconnect between farm tractors and implements that require power connections. The HDB breakaway plug is designed to break the connection before damaging the wiring system. These plugs can be specified with pin or socket contacts and connect only with the HD30 series receptacles. As an added design convenience, the HDB breakaway plug is also available with an optional cable clamp (059 mod). Breakaway function occurs at an axial load of 50-100 lbs. L015/L017/L024 MODIFICATIONS L015 Threaded Adapter L017 Ring Adapter The L015/L024 threaded adapters and L017 ring adapter modifications are available for the DEUTSCH HDP20 series connectors. These adapter modifications provide simple, low cost assembly solutions for applications that require a backshell or conduit. The adapters are designed to be used with the backshell of your choice. • The L015 threaded adapter is available on size 24 shells in the HDP20 series. • The L017 ring adapter is available on size 24 or size 18 shells in the HDP20 series. • The L024 wide threaded adapter is available on size 24 or size 18 shells L024 Wide Threaded Adapter in the HDP20 series. C030 MODIFICATION Originally designed for multiplexing and battery cable applications, the DEUTSCH C030 modification is an environmentally sealed, heavy duty two cavity connector that accepts size 4 solid contacts rated up to 100 amps for each cavity. The C030 modification is available in size 18 shell in both metal (HD30 series) and thermoplastic (HDP20 series) to meet your heavy wire gauge application needs. PAGE 153 HD30 & HDP20 Series C041/CL20 MODIFICATIONS The C041 and CL20 modifications are available for the DEUTSCH HDP20 series 14 pin connector. The C041 modification features a data link key and reduced diameter seals on the receptacle. The CL20 modification includes a ring adapter, reduced diameter seals, and a data link key on the plug. CABLE CLAMP/BACKSHELL MODIFICATIONS DEUTSCH cable clamps provide positive support to the wire bundle while reducing strain on the connector. The backshell is available with or without drain holes. Part Number Suffix Description -072 Adapter only -059 Adapter and cable clamp assembly with drain holes -L006 Adapter and cable clamp assembly without drain holes Accessories Several accessory items can be used to complement the connectors. The HD30 & HDP20 family accessories include items such as boots, backshells, gaskets, and protective caps. Accessories are designed to complete the application and meet a wide array of design requirements such as solutions for mounting, providing additional protection, and offering increased aesthetics. ut LAD D l u si v e t ion xc o E BOOTS D i s t ri b Boots provide a professional looking finishing touch for the DEUTSCH HD30 & HDP20 family of connectors. Made of durable plastisol, these slip-on boots are not only aesthetically appealing, but also provide increased protection from dirt, paint overspray, and pressure washing. The plastisol boots are rated from -20°F to +212°F (-28°C to +100°C) and offer a slip-on design making installation quick and easy. Part Number Description HD30-18BT 18 shell size boot, gray HD30-18BT-BK 18 shell size boot, black HD30-18BT-90-BK 18 shell size boot, 90° bend, black LC-90BT-HT 18 shell size boot, 90° bend, high temperature material, yellow HD30-24BT 24 shell size boot, gray HD30-24BT-BK 24 shell size boot, black HD30-24BT-90-BK 24 shell size boot, 90° bend, black MT-90BT-HT-24 24 shell size boot, 90° bend, high temperature material, yellow *Distorting the boots can lessen their longevity INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS HD30 & HDP20 Series PROTECTIVE DUST CAPS Protective caps are available for both plug and receptacle halves of the connectors. The metal caps, for use with the HD30 series, come with a mounting chain and are used to protect the connector while not mated. The thermoplastic caps, for use with the HDP20 series, are available with or without a lanyard. HDP20 Series Dust Caps Shell Size Part Number Description 18 HDC26-18 24 HDC26-24 Plug cap for receptacle protection, environmentally sealed HD30 Series Dust Caps Shell Size Part Number 18 HDC36-18 24 HDC36-24 18 HDC34-18 24 HDC34-24 Description Plug cap for receptacle protection Receptacle cap for plug protection *To order HD30(HD3*-**) protective caps without the mounting chain, add -1E to the end of the part number STRAIN RELIEF The DEUTSCH HD30 & HDP20 series connectors offer several backshell options to meet your design needs. Backshell options include straight or 90° and plastic or metal. The metal backshells work best with the HD30 series. It is attached to the rear of the connector using an adjustable screw and is secured to the wire bundle with the use of a tie wrap. The plastic backshells work best with the HDP20 series and attach to the rear of the connector with either a clamshell snap closure or by screwing them on to a threaded adapter. The rigid, durable backshells offer a high level of protection, provide strain relief, and improve aesthetics. Shell Size 18 24 18 24 Orientation Straight 90° HD30 Series Backshell Part Number WHDS-18-1 WHDS-24-1 WHDS-18-2 WHDS-24-2 PAGE 155 HD30 & HDP20 Series Shell Size Orientation HDP20 Series L017 Backshell Part Number Straight 2428-016-1805 13, 17, 19 (mm) NW 90° 2428-015-1805 13, 17, 19 (mm) NW Straight 2428-008-2405 1” 90° 2428-004-2405 1” Straight 2428-010-2405 17, 19, 23, 26 (mm) NW 90° 2428-011-2405 17, 19, 23, 26 (mm) NW 18 24 24 Conduit Size NW = Nominal Width of the conduit’s inside diameter. See drawings for full specifications. Shell Size 24 Seal Ring HDP20 Series L015 Conduit Adapter Part Number Seal Ring SRN21 Cap Nut CN21 Conduit Size 22 (mm) NW Cap Nut ut LAD D l u si v e t ion xc o E BACKSHELLS FOR L015 MODIFICATION D i s t ri b The DEUTSCH HDP20 series backshells are designed to screw onto connectors with the L015 modification, which adds a threaded adapter. Rated for temperatures from -40°C to +134°C, the rigid, durable backshells offer a high level of protection, provide strain relief, and improve aesthetics. HDP20 Series L015 Shell Size Backshell Compression Nut 24 Cable Diameter Backshell Part Number Compression Nut Part Number .430-.570 M902-2243 M902-2053 .570-.710 M902-2244 M902-2054 Backshell Technical Specifications: Material - PC/PET Polyester Blend, UV-Stabilized, Flame Retardant, Black Flammability - material meets UL94-VO, Weatherability - UL746C INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS HD30 & HDP20 Series BACKSHELLS FOR L024 MODIFICATION The DEUTSCH HDP20 series backshells are designed to screw onto connectors with the L024 modification, which adds a wide threaded adapter. The rigid, durable backshells offer a high level of protection, provide strain relief, and improve aesthetics. Shell Size 18 24 Orientation HDP20 Series L024 Backshell Part Number 2428-025-1805 Straight 2428-024-2405 ut LAD D Moisture, dirt, salt, sand, and road debris can all work their way into electrical panels through unsealed mounting flanges. Rated to operate in environments from -70°F to +225°F (-56°C to +107°C), these rugged high quality neoprene gaskets form a tight seal between the panel face and connector flange to help keep out destructive elements. The gaskets have a thickness of .125” and the material meets the UL-94-HBF, Mil-R-6130C, and FMVSS-302 flammability specifications. l u si v e t ion xc o E GASKETS D i s t ri b Receptacle Shell Size Gasket Part Number 18 16-04978 24 16-04477 MOUNTING HARDWARE DEUTSCH lockwashers and panel nuts are available to aid in mounting the HD30 and HDP20 series connectors. The lockwashers are used to add tension between the threads and the nut to provide a secure mount. The lockwasher and the panel nut should be used together. ØA Shell Size 18 B 24 Series Panel Lockwasher Part Number ØA B HDP20 2414-002-1886 1.892 (48.06) - HD30 114021 1.699 (43.15) .062 (1.57) HDP20 2414-001-2486 2.080 (52.83) - HD30 112264 1.887 (47.93 .062 (1.57) Dimensions are for reference only PAGE 157 HD30 & HDP20 Series A Panel Nut Mounting Torque B Shell Size 18 24 HD30 series 18 shell size 260-280 IN. LB. (29.4-31.6 N.M.) HDP20 series 18 shell size 45-55 IN. LB. (5.1-6.1 N.M.) HD30 series 24 shell size 350-375 IN. LB. (39.5-42.6 N.M.) HDP20 series 24 shell size 65-75 IN. LB. (7.4-8.4 N.M.) Series Panel Nut Part Number Material HDP20 2411-002-1805 Plastic HD30 114020-90 Metal HDP20 2411-001-2405 Plastic HD30 112263-90 Metal A B 1.685 (42.80) 1.875 (47.63) .250 (6.35) .178 (4.52) .250 (6.35) .178 (4.52) Dimensions are for reference only Mounting RECEPTACLE MOUNTING Flat AØ ± .005 (0.13) B +.010 (0.25) -.000 (0.00) Panel Nut Lockwasher .1875 (4.76) .0625 (1.59) Connector Receptacle Recommended Size of Mounting Hole Shell Size ØA B 18 1.507 (38.28) 1.442 (36.63) 24 1.696 (43.08) 1.632 (41.45) Dimensions are for reference only INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS helpful hint Mounting connectors horizontally allows proper water drainage. HD30 & HDP20 Series The D hole punch is a hand tool used to cut a D shaped hole. The D shaped hole allows the connector to be securely mounted and helps prevent the connector from spinning. ut LAD D l u si v e t ion xc o E D HOLE PUNCH D i s t ri b • Punchable Material: Up to .078” mild steel or aluminum. Up to .1875” plastic, wood, paneling, or other soft material. • Tool Material: A2 material heat treated to a Rockwell hardness of 60 to 62. • Tool Size: (rough dimensions) 5.5”L x 2”H x 2”D • Sharpening: The tool can be sharpened as needed. • Usability: A .625” minimum pilot hole is required to accommodate the draw stud. Air tools can be used. Counter nut Die Die Draw Stud * Counter nut Shell Size D Hole Punch Part Number 18 18-D-PUNCH 24 24-D-PUNCH Exploded view *The rods included with the “D” hole punch are used to remove the cutout and are not used in the cutting process. How To Instructions MATING INSTRUCTIONS To mate the plug and the receptacle, line up the index groove on the plug with the flat surface on the receptacle, turn 1/4 turn clockwise. You will feel and hear the pieces snap into the locked position. To unmate the plug and receptacle, release the coupling ring by turning it counter-clockwise. Visually Inspectable Bayonet for Proper Mating Polarizing Indicator HDP20 series & HD30 series Mate Mating Slot Positions Unmate Note Connector Receptacle When mating or unmating connectors, disassemble by hand. Do not use pliers or any other tool. PAGE 159 HD30 & HDP20 Series CONTACT INSERTION Step 1: Grasp contact approximately one inch behind the contact crimp barrel. Step 2: Hold connector with the rear grommet facing you. Step 3: Push contact straight into connector grommet until a positive stop is felt. A slight tug will confirm that it is properly locked in place. Step 2: Step 3: Slide tool along the wire into the insert cavity until it engages contact and resistance is felt. Pull contact wire assembly out of connector. CONTACT REMOVAL Step 1: With rear insert toward you, snap appropriate size removal tool over the wire of contact to be removed. Note Do not twist or insert tool at an angle. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Contents STRIKE Series Overview..................................... 162 Performance Specifications................................ 162 Material Specifications.......................................... 162 Dimensions................................................................ 163 Configurations.......................................................... 163 Ordering Information............................................. 164 Accessories................................................................ 165 How To Instructions...................................... 166-167 STRIKE Series STRIKE Series Overview The STRIKE connector series features a lever lock system and is designed for heavy duty equipment applications. The environmentally sealed series offers two different size rugged housings that accept contacts from size 20 to 16 with arrangements of 32 and 64 cavities. DEUTSCH CONNECTOR PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Temperature: Operating at temperatures -55°C to +125°C Durability: No electrical or mechanical defects after 100 cycles of engagement and disengagement. Vibration: No unlocking or unmating and exhibits no mechanical or physical damage after sinusoidal vibration levels of 20 G’s at 10 to 2000 Hz in each of the three mutually perpendicular planes. No electrical discontinuities longer than 1 microsecond. Fluid Resistance: Connectors show no damage when exposed to most fluids used in industrial applications. Insulation Resistance: 1000 megohms minimum at 25°C. Immersion: IP68 rating Moisture Resistance: Properly wired and mated connections will withstand immersion under three feet of water without loss of electronic qualities or leakage. Dielectric Withstanding Voltage: Current leakage less than 2 milliamps at 1500 volts AC. Thermal Cycle: No cracking, chipping or leaking after 20 test cycles from -55°C to +125°C. MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS Flange Seal: Silicone rubber Plug Grommet: Silicone rubber Receptacle Threaded Inserts: Brass Shell: Glass filled PBT TPA: Glass filled PBT INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS STRIKE Series DIMENSIONS E B C A F STRIKE Plug D STRIKE Receptacle Overall Length A Overall Height B Overall Width C Overall Length D Overall Height E Overall Width F MD 3.189 (81.00) 1.909 (84.50) 1.531 (38.90) 3.228 (82.00) 2.205 (56.00) 1.575 (40.00) FL 3.358 (85.28) 1.913 (48.60) 2.780 (70.60) 3.228 (82.00) 2.205 (56.00) 2.953 (75.00) Cavity Dimensions are for reference only. CONFIGURATIONS Connector Styles Insert Arrangement I In-line F Flange Mount Receptacle P PCB Receptacle MD*-32A 4 Size 16 28 Size 20 I, F, P XX*-XX X size XX X, X, X Shell Size/Key - Configuration Number and Size of Cavities FL*-64A 8 Size 16 56 Size 20 I, F PAGE 163 STRIKE Series PART NUMBERING SYSTEM Part Number SRK 06 - FLA - 32A - 001  Series Cable Attachment Style 001 02 Receptacle 06 Plug 13 PCB Receptacle, 90° Pins 15 PCB Receptacle, Straight Pins Standard Attachment Configuration Key A-J (MD and FL size) Shell Size MD Medium FL Full ORDERING INFORMATION Here are some of the common part numbers of the STRIKE connectors. Several additional connectors may be available. Position 32 64 Keying Plug Receptacle A SRK06-MDA-32A-001 SRK02-MDA-32A-001 B SRK06-MDB-32A-001 SRK02-MDB-32A-001 C SRK06-MDC-32A-001 SRK02-MDC-32A-001 A SRK06-MDA-64A-001 SRK02-MDA-64A-001 B SRK06-MDB-64A-001 SRK02-MDB-64A-001 C SRK06-MDC-64A-001 SRK02-MDC-64A-001 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS STRIKE Series WIRE SEALING RANGE The wire sealing range is the recommended outside diameter of the wire insulation required to maintain an environmental seal in the rear connector cavities. Contact Size Standard Seal 20 16-22 AWG (1.0-0.35mm2) .061-.095 (1.55-2.41) 16 14-20 AWG (2.0-0.5mm2) .061-.120 (1.55-3.05) Accessories Backshells can be used to complement STRIKE connectors. The backshells are designed to snap onto the connectors and accept convoluted tubing. The backshells assist with wire routing to ease engagement and disengagement of the lever lock. Part Number Size Orientation Convoluted Tubing SRK-BS-MD-90-001 SRK-BS-MD-90-002 Medium SRK-BS-FL-90-001 SRK-BS-FL-90-002 Full NW22 & 26(-001) NW26(-002) SRK-BS-MD-ST-001 SRK-BS-MD-ST-002 Medium NW17(-001) NW22(-002) SRK-BS-FL-ST-001 SRK-BS-FL-ST-002 Full 90° Straight NW17 & 22(-001) NW22(-002) NW22(-001) NW26(-002) Description 90° plastic backshell for medium or full size plugs and receptacles Straight plastic backshell for medium or full size plugs and receptacles PAGE 165 STRIKE Series How To Instructions CONTACT INSERTION Step 1: Confirm TPA locking is open. Step 2: Hold connector with rear seal retainer facing you. Step 4: Push to close the TPA. TPA will not close unless all contacts are fully seated in connector. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Step 3: Push contact straight into the grommet until a positive stop is felt. A slight tug will confirm that it is properly locked in place. STRIKE Series CONTACT REMOVAL Step 1: Use DT-RT1 to gently pry the locking clip and release the TPA. Step 2: Repeat step 1 on the other side of the TPA. Step 3: Remove the TPA. Step 4: Unlock the contacts and pull on the wire. PAGE 167 STRIKE Series NOTES: INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Contents Common Contacts Overview..............................170 Performance Specifications.................................. 171 Wire Sealing Ranges................................................101 Solid Contact Part Numbers................................ 172 Stamped & Formed Contacts Part Numbers............................................................ 173 PCB Pins...................................................................... 174 Crimping...................................................................... 175 Crimp Inspection...................................................... 176 Accessories......................................................... 177-178 How To Instructions........................................179-180 DEUTSCH Common Contacts DEUTSCH Common Contacts Overview Several contacts are used interchangeably across most DEUTSCH connector product lines. This commonality improves performance, reliability, and maintainability by reducing changes in the assembly of the wire harness. The use of the same contact system helps eliminate many of the failures reported in harnesses where hundreds of different terminations are used. CONTACT STYLES Two styles of contacts are available: solid and stamped & formed. Both contact types use a crimp style termination, eliminating the need for solder. The variations in the contact system are those dictated by wire gauge and contact style. Solid The solid contacts are designed for use with larger wire size and heavy duty applications. Solid contacts are manufactured using a cold heading process with solid copper alloy wire and are available with either a nickel or gold plating finish. Solid contacts terminate wire from 4 AWG to 20 AWG (25 - 0.5mm2) and are available in 5 sizes each of the pin and socket. The applicable contact is determined by the size of the conductor only. Stamped & Formed Stamped & formed contacts are designed for use where wire termination costs are of primary concern without sacrificing reliability of electrical circuits. The stamped & formed contacts are made on a precision stamping machine using flat strip stock, then a durable and corrosion proof nickel, tin, or optional gold plating is applied. The stamped & formed style contacts terminate wire from 10 AWG to 22 AWG (6.0 - 0.35mm2) and are available in multiple sizes to accommodate a wide range of wire insulation. The specific contact is determined by the outside diameter of wire insulation and conductor size. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DEUTSCH Common Contacts DEUTSCH CONTACT PERFORMANCE SPECIFICATIONS Crimp Tensile Strength (Solid) Contact Size Tensile Strength Size 20 20 lbs Size 16 25 lbs Size 12 70 lbs Size 8 90 lbs Size 4 300 lbs Durability No electrical or mechanical defects after 100 cycles of engagement and disengagement. Current Rating (Contact current rating at 125° C continuous) Contact Size Max. Current Size 20 7.5 amps Size 16 13 amps Size 12 25 amps Size 8 60 amps Size 4 100 amps Crimp Tensile Strength (Stamped & Formed) Contact Size Tensile Strength Size 20 20 lbs Size 16 25 lbs Size 12 70 lbs Contact Retention (Solid and Stamped & Formed) Contacts withstand a minimum load of: 20 lbs (89 N) for size 20 25 lbs (111 N) for size 16 30 lbs (133 N) for size 12 35 lbs (156 N) for size 8 35 lbs (156 N) for size 4 Contact Millivolt Drop Contact Test Current Millivolt Millivolt Size Amps Drop* (Solid) Drop* (S&F) 20 7.5 60 100 16 13 60 100 12 25 60 100 8 60 60 - 4 100 60 - helpful hint A crimp tensile test easily and rapidly identifies a proper crimp. *Less drop through wire PAGE 171 DEUTSCH Common Contacts SOLID CONTACT PART NUMBERS Solid Contact Part Numbers Size Pin Socket Wire Size AWG (mm2) Recommended Strip Length Inches (mm) Min. Contact Retention Ref Crimp Tensile Lbs. (N) Max Rated Amps at 125° C Continuous 20 0460-202-20** 0462-201-20** 20 (0.50) .156-.218 (3.96-5.54) 20 (89) 20 (89) 7.5 20 0460-010-20** 0462-005-20** 16-18 (1.0-0.75) .156-.218 (3.96-5.54) 20 (89) 20 (89) 7.5 16 0460-202-16** 0462-201-16** 16-20 (1.5-0.50) .250-.312 (6.35-7.92) 25 (111) 35-20 (156-89) 13 16 0460-215-16** 0462-209-16** 14 (2.0) .250-.312 (6.35-7.92) 25 (111) 70 (311) 13 12 0460-204-12** 0462-203-12** 12-14 (3.0-2.0) .222-.284 (5.64-7.21) 30 (134) 75-70 (334-311) 25 8 0460-204-08** 0462-203-08** 8-10 (10.0-5.0) .430-.492 (10.92-12.50) 35 (156) 125-90 (556-400) 60 4 0460-204-04** 0462-203-04** 6 (16.0-13.0) .430-.492 (10.92-12.50) 35 (156) 300 (1334) 100 4 4 5960-203-04141 5962-203-04141 (C038) (25.0-21.0) .430-.492 (10.92-12.50) 35 (156) 300 (1334) 100 ** = Plating codes Solid Contact Plating Codes Part Number Suffix Note Plating Material See information drawing 31 Gold 0425-015-0000. 90 Nickel (size 4 pin only) 141 Nickel INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DEUTSCH Common Contacts STAMPED & FORMED CONTACT PART NUMBERS S&F Contact Part Numbers Size Pin Socket Carrier Strip Wire Size AWG (mm2) Max Rated Wire Recommended Min. Amps at Insulation Strip Length Contact 125° C O.D. Range Inches (mm) Retention Continuous 20 1060-20-01** 1062-20-01** 20-01 16-22 (1.5-0.35) .075-.125 (1.91-3.18) .150-.200 (3.81-5.08) 20 (89) 7.5 20 1060-20-02** 1062-20-02** 20-02 16-22 (1.5-0.35) .051-.085 (1.30-2.16) .150-.200 (3.81-5.08) 20 (89) 7.5 1062-20-03** 20-03 sleeveless 16-22 (1.5-0.35) .075-.125 (1.91-3.18) .150-.200 (3.81-5.08) 20 (89) 7.5 14-16 (2.5-1.0) .075-.125 (1.91-3.18) .150-.200 (3.81-5.08) 20 (89) 7.5 20 20 - 1060-20-06** 1062-20-06** 20-06 16 1060-14-01** 1062-14-01** 14-16 14-18 (2.0-.75) .095-.150 (2.41-3.81) .150-.200 (3.81-5.08) 25 (111) 13 16 1060-14-10** 1062-14-10** 14-16 14-18 (2.0-.75) .095-.150 (2.41-3.81) .150-.200 (3.81-5.08) 25 (111) 13 16 1060-16-01** 1062-16-01** 16-18 14-18 (2.0-.75) .075-.140 (1.90-3.55) .150-.200 (3.81-5.08) 25 (111) 13 16 1060-16-06** 1062-16-06** 0.5-1.0 16-20 (1.0-.50) .055-.100 (1.40-2.54) .150-.200 (3.81-5.08) 25 (111) 13 16 1060-16-09** 1062-16-09** 16-18 14-18 (2.0-.75) .075-.140 (1.90-3.55) .150-.200 (3.81-5.08) 25 (111) 13 16 1060-16-12** 1062-16-12** 1.0-2.5 12-16 (2.5-1.0) .075-.140 (1.90-3.55) .175-.225 (4.45-5.72) 25 (111) 13 16 - 1062-16-14** sleeveless 14-16 12-16 (2.5-1.0) .075-.140 (1.90-3.55) .175-.225 (4.45-5.72) 25 (111) 13 12 1060-12-01** 1062-12-01** 12-14 12-14 (4.0-2.0) .113-.176 (2.87-4.47) .225-.275 (5.72-6.99) 30 (134) 25 12 1060-12-02** 1062-12-02** 10-12 10† (6.0-4.0) .140-.204 (3.56-5.18) .225-.275 (5.72-6.99) 30 (134) 25 ** = Plating codes † = TXL wire insulation is preferred S&F Contact Plating Codes Part Number Suffix Plating Material 22 Nickel 44 Gold 66 Tin/Nickel 77 Tin 88 Selective Gold Note See information drawing 0425-015-0000. PAGE 173 DEUTSCH Common Contacts PCB PINS Straight reduced diameter extended pins are available for installation in the DEUTSCH family of connectors. The use of removable contacts provides design flexibility and a low cost alternative to meet application needs. These solid copper alloy pins may be specified in various platings and assembled in HD30, HDP20, HD10, DRC, or DT receptacles. Material Copper alloy Plating Codes 31: Gold 90: Tin 141: Nickel PCB Mounting Consult factory for PCB mounting details and pin positions. End of Connector D A Note B C See information drawing 0425202-0000 for full specifications. Contact Size 20 16 12 Part Number A B C 0460-208-2031 1.305 (33.15) .248 (6.30) 0460-208-2090 1.305 (33.15) 0460-208-16141 Series D* .025 (.64) HD30/HDP20 .939 (23.85) .248 (6.30) .025 (.64) HD10 .925 (23.50) 1.300 (33.02) .248 (6.30) .025 (.64) DT .777 (19.74) 0460-208-1631 1.300 (33.02) .248 (6.30) .025 (.64) DT04-2P .677 (17.20) 0460-229-16141 .545 (13.84) .248 (6.30) .025 (.64) DT04-3P .677 (17.20) 0460-241-16141 1.305 (33.15) .160 (4.06) .040 (1.02) DRC 1.063 (27.00) 0460-244-16141 .976 (24.79) .400 (10.16) .041 (1.04) 0460-244-1631 .976 (24.79) .400 (10.16) .041 (1.04) 0460-208-12141 1.305 (33.15) .248 (6.30) .025 (.64) 0460-245-1231 1.024 (26.01) .500 (12.70) .041 (1.04) 0460-245-1290 1.024 (26.01) .500 (12.70) .041 (1.04) *D is equal to the distance from the contact shoulder to the end of the connector. Dimensions are for reference only. HD10 Series HDP20 Series INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS HD30 Series DEUTSCH Common Contacts Crimping Crimping is defined as the act of joining a conductor to a pin or socket contact using a mechanical tool to compress and displace metal. In a good crimp joint, there is mutual flow of metal, causing a symmetrical distortion of wire strands. CRIMPING CONFIGURATIONS Stamped & formed contacts use a folded type of crimp (Fig. 1) while solid contacts use a 1, 2, or 4 indent crimp (Fig. 2). In both styles of crimps, the wire strands and the contact material are formed together in a solid mass creating a reduction of the wire strand area. The reduced wire strand area creates a minimum of voids allowing for excellent conductivity. Crimping may be accomplished with hand tools or power tools. Stamped & Formed Style Cross-Section Across Axis Figure 1 BENEFITS OF CRIMPED CONTACTS Solid Style Mechanically crimping contacts is the leading wire termination method for some very good reasons: • With smaller wire, the crimp is as strong as the wire itself. • The joint can be visually inspected. Viewing the wire through an inspection hole in the contact makes inspection quick and easy, both by the operator and the inspector. Indenter Crimp Cross-Section Across Axis Figure 2 • Plating thickness is not restricted, as in solder joints, so better corrosion resistance and contact reliability are achieved. • Crimping can be done anywhere, without special preparation. Terminations are replaced or modified in the field exactly the same as in the shop, using the same tools and the same techniques, and with the same ease of operation and certainty of results. • Total installed and maintenance costs are lower. helpful hint Solder should not be added to DEUTSCH terminals. Note The use of dielectric grease is not recommended. PAGE 175 DEUTSCH Common Contacts CRIMP INSPECTION Crimping tools provide lower total installation and maintenance costs. However, controls are required to help confirm that the proper crimp tools designed for the type and size contact are used, the pin or socket is properly inserted into the tool, the wire insulation is stripped properly, and the wire fully inserts into the contact. When a crimp is completed, correct termination can be visually inspected. The inspector should check for: • The removed insulation should expose a conductor length that will pass beyond the inspection hole in the contact and still reveal the appropriate length of conductor between the contact and the insulation on the wire. • Wire strands intact. • All wire strands enter the contact barrel. • Wire inserted to the proper depth in the contact. When the correct crimp tool and process are used, a good termination results. Note For more detailed crimp dimensions please request a drawing. SOLID CONTACT CRIMP Crimp centered between the inspection hole and crimp barrel end Conductor strands are visible through inspection hole Conductor strands not visible Birdcage Correct insulation gap (.100” max) Acceptable Crimp Flayed wire Unacceptable Crimps STAMPED & FORMED CONTACT CRIMP All strands captured Bare wire strands extended from conductor crimp Conductor strands not visible on both sides of conductor crimp Conductor strand not captured Insulation spaced from conductor crimp area Acceptable Crimp INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Unacceptable Crimps Conductor strands bent and not completely captured DEUTSCH Common Contacts Accessories Additional accessories are available to aid in the design flexibility and sealing requirements of applications. Accessory items such as sealing plugs and keying pins help to maintain an environmental seal and prevent mis-mating. KEYING PINS Keying pins are solid plastic rods used to help prevent mis-mating of like connectors in close proximity. Applicable DEUTSCH product lines include HD10, HD30, HDP20, DT, and DTM series. Keying pins are inserted into the retention fingers of an empty socket cavity. Once installed, the keying pin blocks a mating contact pin from being inserted. The contact pin will be blocked before the coupling device mates the connectors, helping to prevent the mis-mating of like connectors. Proper usage requires that the corresponding mating pin be omitted and a sealing plug inserted in the rear cavity of the mating connector. Individual applications will vary, and testing should be done to determine the best pattern arrangement to help prevent improper connector mating. Part Number Contact Size Color 0413-216-2005 20 Red 0413-215-1605 16 White 0413-214-1205 12 Yellow Note Multiple keying pins may be required to help prevent unintentional forced mating. CONTACT CRIMP SLEEVE REDUCER A crimp sleeve reducer is available to allow DEUTSCH size 4 solid contacts to accept 8-10 AWG wire. When populating a connector using a contact with a reducer sleeve, be sure the insert seal penetrates the rear grommet. The use of the crimp sleeve reducer requires no extra crimp tools and provides an easy transition and increased flexibility. Note TXL wire insulation with 10 AWG is not recommended because it may not provide an environmental Insert Seal 0410-241-0406 Crimp Sleeve 0421-203-04141 seal against the insert seal. PAGE 177 DEUTSCH Common Contacts SEALING PLUGS Open cavities provide pathways for contaminates to enter the connectors. To maintain seal integrity, any unused cavity must be filled with the appropriate size sealing plug. Part Number Contact Size Description 114019 Size 4 Silicone rubber 114018 Size 8 Thermoplastic 114017 Size 12, 16 Thermoplastic 0413-217-1605 (locking sealing plug) Size 16 Thermoplastic, retained by locking fingers 0413-003-1605 Size 16 Thermoplastic, used with STRIKE series 0413-204-2005 Size 20 Thermoplastic helpful hint Sealing plugs are used to seal the connector when all the cavities are not used by wires. Plug INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DEUTSCH Common Contacts How To Instructions SEALING PLUG INSTALLATION Step 1: Holding the sealing plug with large diameter end away from the connector, gently apply downward pressure to force the sealing plug into the cavity. Step 2: With perpendicular motion, apply downward pressure to the large diameter end of the sealing plug. Step 3: Apply pressure until sealing plug is forced to stop by contact with rear grommet. Visually inspect the sealing plug to confirm it is flush with cavity opening. LOCKING SEALING PLUG INSTALLATION Step 1: Holding the sealing plug with large diameter end towards the connector, gently apply downward pressure to force the sealing plug into the cavity. Step 2: With perpendicular motion, apply downward pressure to the small diameter end of the sealing plug. Step 3: Apply pressure until sealing plug locks into place. A slight tug on the sealing plug will confirm it is locked into place. PAGE 179 DEUTSCH Common Contacts CONTACT CRIMP SLEEVE REDUCER ASSEMBLY Step 1: Place crimp sleeve reducer into contact barrel. Step 2: Slide insert seal onto 8-10 AWG wire stopping just at the edge of the stripped insulation. Step 4: Confirm seal is not distorted. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Step 3: Insert wire into barrel of contact and crimp using designated tooling. Contents Tooling Overview..................................................... 182 Automated Tooling..........................................182-184 Hand Tools..........................................................185-186 Removal Tools........................................................... 187 How To Instructions....................................... 188-190 DEUTSCH Tooling Crimp Tool Overview The two types of DEUTSCH contacts are solid and stamped & formed. Both styles of contacts are designed for crimp style terminations - no solder is required or recommended. A crimp style termination displaces the wire strands creating a superior bond between the wire and the contact. Several tools are available for hand and production wire crimping, wire insertion and removal, and wedgelock/terminal position assurance removal. The tools are specific to the solid contacts or the stamped & formed contacts. To create a proper crimp and achieve the highest performance specifications, contacts must be crimped with the recommended tooling. Automated Tooling Overview For higher production volumes, a pneumatic power crimp tool is available for the DEUTSCH solid contacts, and applicator dies for stamped & formed contacts. The HDP-400, a pneumatic solid crimp tool, is a fast, bench-top tool that crimps most DEUTSCH contacts. The HDP-400 has a foot control, and easy-to-change dies and locators for each contact size. TE’s stamped & formed OCEAN applicator dies are heavy duty mini-dies that work in many industry standard presses. The OCEAN applicator dies offer simple adjustments and the flexibility to accept different sized contacts and wire gauge. AUTOMATED TOOLING FOR SOLID CONTACTS Tool Part Number Contact Size Contact Part Number 4 0460-204-0490 0462-203-04141 8 0460-204-08141 0462-203-08141 12 0460-204-12** 0462-203-12** HDP-400 16 20 0460-202-16** 0462-201-16** 0460-215-16** 0462-209-16** 0460-202-20** 0462-201-20** For the appropriate die and locator, see drawing 0425-205-0000 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DEUTSCH Tooling HDP-400 TOOLING ACCESSORIES The Go-No-Go gauge is used to determine if the HDP-400 tool is calibrated within the recommended specifications to produce a proper crimp. Part Number Go-No-Go Gauges GA20N HDP-400 Size 20 450GA-16N HDP-400 Size 16 450GA-12N HDP-400 Size 12 GA8-SPEC HDP-400 Size 8 450GA-4-SPEC HDP-400 Size 4 AUTOMATED TOOLING FOR STAMPED & FORMED CONTACTS Size 16 -Group 1 Size 12 -Group 2 Size 12 -Group 1 Pin P/N 1060-12-0144 1060-12-0166 1060-12-0222 1060-12-0244 Socket P/N 1062-12-0144 1062-12-0166 1062-12-0222 1062-12-0244 Insulation Range O.D. (mm) Applictor P/N Conversion Kit P/N .151-.176 (3.83-4.47) 2266124-1 7-2266124-8 .130-.154 (3.30-3.91) 2266125-1 7-2266125-8 .113-.135 (2.87-3.43) 2266126-1 7-2266127-8 .185-.204 (4.70-5.18) 2266127-1 7-2266127-8 .155-.190 (3.94-4.83) 2266128-1 7-2266128-8 .140-.160 (3.56-4.06) 2266129-1 7-226129-8 1060-14-0122 1060-14-0144 1060-14-0177 1062-14-0122 1062-14-0144 1062-14-0177 .120-.150 (3.05-3.81) 2266100-1 7-2266100-8 1060-14-1077 1060-14-1088 1062-14-1077 1062-14-1088 .105-.125 (2.67-3.18) 2266101-1 7-2266101-8 1060-16-0122 1060-16-0144 1060-16-0177 1062-16-0122 1062-16-0144 1062-16-0177 .105-.125 (2.67-3.18) 2266101-1 7-2266101-8 1060-16-0722 1060-16-0744 1060-16-0777 1062-16-0722 1062-16-0744 1062-16-0777 .085-.111 (2.16-2.82) 2266102-1 7-2266102-8 .075-.105 (1.91-2.67) 2266103-1 7-2266103-8 1060-16-0977 1060-16-0988 1062-16-0977 1062-16-0988 .063-.094 (1.60-2.39) 2266104-1 7-2266104-8 The -1 suffix on the applicator p/n represents a mechanical feed, for other feed options contact your representative. The conversion kit is to convert applicators within the same group. For more information, please reference TE catalog 1-1773730-8 or contact your representative. PAGE 183 DEUTSCH Tooling Size 20 -Group 1 Size 16 -Group 3 Size 16 -Group 2 AUTOMATED TOOLING FOR STAMPED & FORMED CONTACTS (CONTINUED) Pin P/N Socket P/N 1060-16-0622 1060-16-0644 1060-16-0677 1060-16-0688 1062-16-0622 1062-16-0644 1062-16-0677 1062-16-0688 1060-16-1222 1060-16-1244 1060-16-1277 1062-16-1222 1062-16-1244 1062-16-1277 - Insulation Range Applictor P/N O.D. (mm) Conversion Kit P/N .063-.094 (1.60-2.39) 2266110-1 7-2266110-8 .050-.075 (1.27-1.91) 2266111-1 7-2266111-8 .120-.140 (3.05-3.56) 2266112-1 7-2266112-8 .105-.125 (2.67-3.18) 2266113-1 7-2266113-8 1062-16-1422 1062-16-1444 1062-16-1477 .090-.110 (2.29-2.79) 2266114-1 7-2266114-8 .075-.095 (1.91-2.41) 2266115-1 7-2266115-8 1060-20-0122 1060-20-0144 1060-20-0177 1062-20-0122 1062-20-0144 1062-20-0177 .105-.125 (2.67-3.18) 2266116-1 7-2266116-8 - 1062-20-0322 1062-20-0344 1062-20-0377 .085-.111 (2.16-2.82) 2266117-1 7-2266117-8 .075-.105 (1.91-2.67) 2266118-1 7-2266118-8 1060-20-0222 1060-20-0244 1060-20-0277 1062-20-0222 1062-20-0244 1062-20-0277 .063-.085 (1.62-2.16) 2266119-1 7-2266119-8 .050-.075 (1.27-1.91) 2266120-1 7-2266120-8 The -1 suffix on the applicator p/n represents a mechanical feed, for other feed options contact your representative. The conversion kit is to convert applicators within the same group. For more information, please reference TE catalog 1-1773730-8 or contact your representative. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DEUTSCH Tooling Hand Tool Overview For field service, prototype, and low-volume production, there are several easy-to-use hand crimp tools for both solid barrel and stamped & formed contacts. All hand crimp tools provide a tight, complete crimp with minimal effort. The HDT-48-00, the most commonly used tool for solid contacts, crimps a wide range of contact sizes. It provides a symmetrical four indent crimp, is compact and easy-to-use for field service, yet sturdy and reliable enough for low volume production. Hand crimp tools for DEUTSCH stamped & formed contacts are wire gauge specific and simultaneously crimp the insulation and conductor, saving time and effort during field service. HDT-04-08 Contact Size HDT-48-00 Contact Part Number HDT-50-00 ut LAD D l u si v e t ion xc o E HAND TOOLS FOR SOLID CONTACTS D i s t ri b HDT-1561 Tool Part Number Crimp Type 4 0460-204-0490 0462-203-04141 HDT-04-08 Two indent crimp 8 0460-204-08141 0462-203-08141 HDT-04-08 Two indent crimp HDT-48-00 Four indent crimp 12 0460-204-12** 0462-203-12** HDT-1561 Two indent crimp HDT-50-00 One indent crimp HDT-48-00 Four indent crimp HDT-1561 Two indent crimp HDT-50-00 One indent crimp HDT-48-00 Four indent crimp HDT-1561 Two indent crimp HDT-50-00 One indent crimp 16 20 0460-202-16** 0462-201-16** 0460-215-16** 0462-209-16** 0460-202-20** 0462-201-20** PAGE 185 DEUTSCH Tooling HDT-48-00 TOOLING ACCESSORIES Replacement parts, such as adjustment screws, locking nuts, and inspection tools are available for the HDT-48-00 hand tool. Part Number Crimp Tool Replacement Part 0426-209-0000 Adjustment screw and locking nut M2700-395-10 Locking nut Part Number G454 Description HDT-48-00 Go-No-Go Gauge HAND TOOLS FOR DEUTSCH STAMPED & FORMED CONTACTS DTT-12-00 DTT-12-01 Contact Size Contact Part Number 12 16 20 DTT-16-00 DTT-16-01 DTT-20-00 DTT-20-02 Tool Part Number 1060-12-01** 1062-12-01** DTT-12-00 1060-12-02** 1062-12-02** DTT-12-01 1060-16-01** 1062-16-01** 1060-16-06** 1062-16-06** DTT-16-00 (14-16 AWG) DTT-16-01 (18 AWG) 1060-20-01** 1062-20-01** DTT-20-00 1060-20-02** 1062-20-02** DTT-20-02 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS helpful hint Go-no-go gauges are used to inspect crimp tooling. The G454 gauge is used with the HDT-48-00 hand tool. DEUTSCH Tooling MULTI-USE REMOVAL TOOL Part Number DT-RT1 Description Multi-use tool with a small hook on one end for wedgelock removal, and a small screwdriver on the other end to push back the locking fingers and release the contact. For use with the DT, DTM, DTP, DTV, DRB, and STRIKE series. REMOVAL TOOLS DEUTSCH removal tools are designed to simplify contact removal and field service repair in connectors that utilize a round shoulder contact retention system. Removal tools are compact, easy-to-use, and manufactured of heavy duty plastic to remove contacts without damage to the wire, insulation, connector seals, or connector body. The removal tools are required for wire removal in the DTHD, Jiffy Splices, HD10, HDP20, HD30, DRC, AEC, and WT series. Contact Size Wire Gauge Range Color 0411-027-0405 Size 4 4 AWG Black 114009 Size 4 6 AWG White 114008 Size 8 8-10 AWG Green Size 8 for HD Box 8-10 AWG Green Extended 114010 Size 12 12 AWG Yellow 0411-337-1205 Size 12 12-14 AWG Extra Thin Wall (E-Seal) Orange 0411-291-1405 Size 16 14-16 AWG Green 0411-310-1605 Size 16 16-20 AWG Light Blue 0411-336-1605 Size 16 16-18 AWG Extra Thin Wall (E-Seal) Dark Blue 0411-240-2005 Size 20 20-22 AWG Red Part Number 0411-353-0805 helpful hint A contact removal tool taped or tie wrapped to the harness will make it easily available, should repairs be needed. PAGE 187 DEUTSCH Tooling How To Instructions WIRE STRIPPING Step 1: 1. Choose the correct AWG for the contact being used. Step 2: 1. After stripping, a small piece of the insulation should come off. 2. Measure from the end of the wire the recommended strip length according to the contact size. 2. Check for any broken strands or for a dent in the wire. If either exist, the wire is damaged and should be cut and stripped again. 3. Place the wire into a stripping tool at the recommended strip length. Strip the wire according to stripping tool instructions. Step 3: Measure the exposed strands to be sure the crimp length is correct. helpful hint Leaving the stripped portion of the insulation on the wire until crimping will avoid flayed wire strands. Incorrect Correct CRIMPING WITH THE HDT-48-00 HAND TOOL Step 1: 1. Strip insulation from wire. 2. Raise selector knob and rotate until arrow is aligned with wire size to be crimped. Step 2: Insert contact with barrel up. Turn adjusting screw counter­clockwise until contact is flush with indentor cover. Tighten locknut. 3. Loosen locknut, turn adjusting screw in until it stops. Step 3: 1. Insert wire into contact. Contact must be centered between indentors. Close handles until crimp cycle is completed. 2. Release handles and remove crimped contact. Note Tool must be adjusted for each type/size of contact. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DEUTSCH Tooling CRIMPING WITH DTT STYLE HAND TOOLS (SIZE 16 & 20) Step 1: Cycle the hand tool to the open position. Place the contact into the correct die nest. Step 2: Partially close the tool until the contact is held in place. Step 3: Insert the prestripped wire into the crimp area of the contact. Step 4: Close the tool until the ratchet releases. The ratchet is released when a loud click is heard and crimp is complete. PAGE 189 DEUTSCH Tooling CRIMPING WITH DTT-12-01 HAND TOOL Proper contact position, front view Insulation diameters Proper contact position, side view Insulation selector Step 1: Cycle handles to release ratchet and fully open crimp jaws. Pull out insulation selector and push into proper diameter using the chart below. Wire Type Insulation Selector 10 TXL 10 GXL 10 SXL 5.0 mm2 6.0 mm2 .150-.170 .160-.180 .170-.205 .160-.180 .170-.205 Step 2: 1. Insert contact into locator. Adjust alignment and width of crimp wings if necessary to help confirm capture by crimp jaws. 2. Insert stripped wire into the contact. Close crimp tool until full-cycle ratchet control releases. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Contents Bussed Feedback Overview................................ 192 Bussed Examples..................................................... 192 Dimensions................................................................. 193 Ordering Information..............................................194 Bussing Options Bussed Overview DEUTSCH industrial bussed feedback receptacles are environmentally sealed connectors designed for use in heavy duty applications where multiple circuits require a common electrical pathway. Available in the DT Series, DEUTSCH bussed connectors feature integrated bussbars with standard DEUTSCH contacts. A bussbar, or buss, is a thin conductive strip connecting two or more contacts within the body of a connector. Bussbars allow power or data to be fed into a connector through one or more terminals and drawn out as needed through the other contacts on the same buss. Connectors can carry one or more bussbars, creating multiple independent electrical circuits within the same connector body and distributing power or data to many components. A single bussed connector can replace several standard connectors or splices, saving space, wiring, and weight. DT SERIES BUSSED FEEDBACK RECEPTACLES DT bussed feedback receptacles are a compact economical bussing option housed in rugged, field-proven DT receptacle bodies. The bussed DTs mate with standard DT plugs and meet all the performance specifications for the DT series. The connectors are available in multiple buss configurations using standard size 16 contacts, with plating options in nickel or gold. BUSSED EXAMPLES 10 amps 6.5 amps 3 amps 13 amps 6.5 amps 13 amps In the examples, there are three size 16 pins each rated for 13 amps mounted to the buss. A total of 13 amps can be pulled into one pin and going out the 13 amps are split between the remaining two pins. No more than 13 amps can go through any single pin. Note The maximum current rating is the total amount of current for the entire buss. Current can be distributed in many combinations, but cannot exceed 13 amps per contact. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Bussing Options DIMENSIONS B A C DT Receptacle Overall Length A Overall Height B Overall Width C 2 1.818 (46.18) .670 (17.15) .675 (17.15) 4 1.868 (47.45) .797 (20.24) .820 (20.83) 6 1.858 (47.19) .972 (24.69) .820 (20.83) 8 1.848 (46.94) 1.000 (25.40) 1.435 (36.45) 12 2.043 (51.89) .876 (22.25) 1.597 (40.56) Cavity Dimensions are for reference only. DT SERIES BUSSED FEEDBACK RECEPTACLE PART NUMBERING SYSTEM Part Number DT 04 - 4 P * - **** Series Special Modifications Style Key (if applicable) 04 In-line Receptacle Configuration Contacts P Pin PAGE 193 Bussing Options ORDERING INFORMATION Bussing Arrangements Maximum Current Rating* Buss Plating Connector Color Receptacle Part Number Mating Plug Part Number (1) 2 Pin Buss=13 amps Nickel Black DT04-2P-P060 DT06-2S-**** (1) 4 Pin Buss=26 amps Nickel Nickel Black Gray DT04-4P-EP13 DT04-4P-P021 DT06-4S-**** DT06-4S-**** (1) 6 Pin Buss=39 amps Nickel Nickel Black Gray DT04-6P-EP13 DT04-6P-P021 DT06-6S-**** DT06-6S-**** (2) 3 Pin Busses=13 amps each Nickel Black DT04-6P-EP14 DT06-6S-**** (1) 8 Pin Buss=52 amps Nickel Nickel Gray Black DT04-08PA-P021 DT04-08PB-P021 DT06-08SA-**** DT06-08SB-**** (1) 3 Pin Buss=13 amps (1) 5 Pin Buss=26 amps Nickel Nickel Gray Black DT04-08PA-P028 DT04-08PB-P028 DT06-08SA-**** DT06-08SB-**** (2) 4 Pin Busses=26 amps each Nickel Nickel Gray Black DT04-08PA-P026 DT04-08PB-P026 DT06-08SA-**** DT06-08SB-**** (1) 12 Pin Buss=78 amps Gold Gold Nickel Nickel Gray Black Gray Black DT04-12PA-P016 DT04-12PB-P016 DT04-12PA-P021 DT04-12PB-P021 DT06-12SA-**** DT06-12SB-**** DT06-12SA-**** DT06-12SB-**** (2) 6 Pin Busses=39 amps each Nickel Nickel Gold Gray Black Black DT04-12PA-P026 DT04-12PB-P026 DT04-12PB-P027 DT06-12SA-**** DT06-12SB-**** DT06-12SB-**** (3) 4 Pin Busses=26 amps each Nickel Gray DT04-12PA-P075 DT06-12SA-**** (4) 3 Pin Busses=13 amps each Nickel Nickel Gold Gold Gray Black Gray Black DT04-12PA-P030 DT04-12PB-P030 DT04-12PA-P031 DT04-12PB-P031 DT06-12SA-**** DT06-12SB-**** DT06-12SA-**** DT06-12SB-**** (1) 2 (1) 4 (1) 6 (2) 3’s (1) 8 (1) 3, (1) 5 (2) 4’s (1) 12 (2) 6’s (3) 4’s (4) 3’s *Maximum current rating is the total amperage for the buss INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Contents Controller Area Networks (CAN) Overview.....................................................................196 ISO Box........................................................................196 J1939/11 9-pin Diagnostic..............................198-199 J1939/13 Connector Options.....................200-201 J1939/15 Connector Options.................... 202-203 Controller Area Networks CAN Overview Controller Area Networks, or CAN, are multiplex data systems. Multiplexing allows multiple data signals to travel on the same wires, integrating separate electronic systems and applications to a single point control and monitoring system. Using signals sent over a serial network, CAN systems provide instantaneous monitoring of diagnostic and control systems allowing early detection of potential problems. Early detection of problems leads to lower repair costs and reduced downtime. CAN systems allow an operator to use a single command station to control diagnostic systems and receive such varied information as brake and transmission temperature, tire pressure, fuel efficiency, and emissions levels. Anything that can be measured and controlled electronically can be monitored and directed by a CAN system. ISO/CD 11783-2 ISO BOX AND ASSOCIATED CONNECTORS Originally designed for agricultural applications, the DEUTSCH ISO Box creates a communication pathway between an on-board CAN system and the electronic components on an attached implement. The HDBox, which holds two DT13 connectors and an HD30 series receptacle, mounts on the vehicle and mates with an HD30 plug connector that features a breakaway coupling ring. DEUTSCH breakaway couplings are designed to help prevent damage to the vehicle or the attached implement by fragmenting and separating from the vehicle in the event of a drive-away disconnect. Part Number Description HDBOX-24-91PN ISO Box assembly HDBOX-24-91PE ISO Box assembly, reduced wire seal HD36-24-91SN-059 Plug, cable clamp assembly HD36-24-91SE-059 Plug, cable clamp assembly, reduced wire seal HDB36-24-91SN-059 Plug, breakaway coupling, cable clamp assembly HDB36-24-91SE-059 Plug, breakaway coupling, cable clamp assembly, reduced wire seal DT06-4S-EP06* Plug, black, end cap DT06-2S-EP06* Plug, black, end cap W4S-P012 Wedgelock, green W2S-P012 Wedgelock, green 0460-204-08141 Pin, solid, size 8 0460-204-12141 Pin, solid, size 12 0460-202-1631 Pin, solid, size 16, gold 0462-203-08141 Socket, solid, size 8 0462-203-12141 Socket, solid, size 12 0462-201-1631 Socket, solid, size 16, gold *DT series receptacles are molded in the HDBox INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Controller Area Networks CAN PRODUCT OPTIONS Whether you’re building a Controller Area Network for anything from on/ off-highway, construction, material handling, agriculture machines, to your OEM fleet of fire engines, there is a DEUTSCH solution for your CAN needs. Options include several configurations: 2-wire, 3-wire, and 4-wire, with in-line and flange mount, along with splitters, heavy duty breakaway connectors, and an off-board 9-pin diagnostic connector. SAE J1939 is a specific type of CAN that defines the communications pathways for vehicle networks. Improved electrical systems as defined under SAE J1939 allow electrical devices to communicate with each other. Communication occurs using a Controlled Area Network between intelligent sensors over a serial network. Through a series of microprocessors a CAN interconnects every device establishing a common link between each. There are three main electrical interconnect subsets of J1939 including /11, /13, and /15: • J1939/11 is a 3-wire system that uses the DEUTSCH DT series connectors primarily for truck and bus. The DT series accepts size 16 contacts and 14-20 AWG. Connector options include in-line, bulkhead, “Y” splitter, and terminating resistors. • J1939/13 is a system that uses the DEUTSCH HD10 series connectors for on-board diagnostics. The HD10 series accepts size 16 contacts and 14-20 AWG. • J1939/15 is a 2-wire system that uses the DEUTSCH DTM series connectors. The DTM series accepts size 20 contacts and 16-22 AWG. Connector options include in-line, “Y” splitter, and terminating resistors. The sophistication of equipment design is demanding increased response of electrical systems. The application of J1939 allows designers to improve the quantity and the quality of the options offered along with increased electrical system reliability. PAGE 197 Controller Area Networks J1939/11 3 WIRE SYSTEM SCHEMATIC DEUTSCH J1939/11 connectors are rugged field proven DT 3 pin connectors designed to meet the SAE requirements for 3-wire CAN applications linking ECUs for serial data communications. The DT 3 way connectors accommodate the CAN_HI, CAN_LO and shield wires with a variety of options including “Y” receptacles, connectors with mounting flanges, keyed wedgelocks to prevent mis-mating, and network terminating connectors with molded-in 120Ω resistors. ECU I ECU II Receptacle-ADT04-3P-E008 DT04-3P-EE01 Wedge-AW3P Receptacle-ADT04-3P-LE08 Wedge-AW3P Plug-ADT06-3S-P032 Wedge-AW3S-P012 Plug-ADT06-3S-P032 Wedge-AW3S-P012 Terminating Receptacle DT04-3P-P006 DT04-3P-EP10 Wedgelock Included Plug-BDT06-3S-P032 Wedge-BW3S-1939-P012 Receptacle-ADT04-3P-LE08 Wedge-AW3P Plug-ADT06-3S-P032 Wedge-AW3S-P012 Receptacle-BDT04-3P-LE08 Wedgelock-BW3P-1939 Plug-BDT06-3S-P032 Wedge-BW3S-1939-P012 ECU II + I Receptacle-YDT04-3P-P007 Plug-BDT06-3S-P032 Wedge-BW3S-1939-P012 +Battery Plug-BDT06-3S-P032 Wedge-BW3S-1939-P012 Terminating Receptacle DT04-3P-P006 DT04-3P-EP10 Wedgelock Included INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Controller Area Networks J1939/11 DEUTSCH CONNECTOR OPTIONS Part Number Description DT04-3P-P007 Receptacle, “y” connector DT04-3P-E008 Receptacle, gray, shrink boot adapter DT04-3P-P006 Receptacle, gray, 120Ω resistor DT04-3P-EE01 Receptacle, black, shrink boot adapter DT04-3P-EP10 Receptacle, black, 120Ω resistor DT06-3S-E008 Plug, gray, shrink boot adapter DT06-3S-P006 Plug, gray, 120Ω resistor DT06-3S-EP11 Plug, black, shrink boot adapter DT06-3S-PP01 Plug, black, 120Ω resistor DT06-3S-PE01 Plug, black, 120Ω resistor, latch guard DT06-3S-P032 Plug, black, single piece shrink boot adapter W3P-1939 Wedgelock, blue W3S Wedgelock, orange W3S-P012 Wedgelock, green W3S-1939 Wedgelock, blue W3S-1939-P012 Wedgelock, blue 0460-202-1631 Pin, solid, size 16, gold 1060-16-0144 Pin, stamped & formed, size 16, gold 0460-247-1631 Pin, solid, size 16, gold, extended 0462-201-1631 Socket, solid, size 16, gold 1062-16-0144 Socket, stamped & formed, size 16, gold 0462-221-1631 Socket, solid, size 16, gold, extended PAGE 199 Controller Area Networks J1939/13 UNIVERSAL 9-PIN DIAGNOSTIC DEUTSCH J1939/13, HD10 9 pin connector is a standard diagnostic tool interface for on- and off-highway OEMs. The HD10-9-1939P is a data port connector designed to allow an on-board CAN system to mate with a diagnostic computer. The connectors are for use with the 250 kbps network. The DEUTSCH HD10 J1939/13 connectors offer several mounting options for the receptacle, and a mating plug that is available with or without a coupling ring. Part Number Description HD10-9-1939P Receptacle HD10-9-1939P-B022 Receptacle, panel nut mount HD10-9-1939PE-B022 Receptacle, panel nut mount, reduced wire seal HD10-9-1939PE Receptacle, reduced wire seal HD16-9-1939S Plug, coupling ring HD16-9-1939SE Plug, coupling ring, reduced wire seal HD17-9-1939S Plug, no coupling ring (slip-on) HD17-9-1939SE Plug, no coupling ring (slip-on), reduced wire seal 0460-202-1631 Pin, solid, size 16, gold 0460-247-1631 Pin, solid, size 16, gold, extended 0462-201-1631 Socket, solid, size 16, gold 0462-221-1631 Socket, solid, size 16, gold, extended INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Controller Area Networks J1939/13 TYPE II UNIVERSAL 9-PIN DIAGNOSTIC DEUTSCH J1939/13, HD10 9 pin connector is a standard diagnostic tool interface for on- and off-highway OEMs. The HD10-9-1939P*-P080 is a data port connector designed to allow an on-board CAN system to mate with a diagnostic computer. The green, Type II connectors, HD10-91939P-P080, are for use with the 500 kbps network. The DEUTSCH HD10 J1939/13 connectors offer several mounting options for the receptacle, and a mating plug that is available with or without a coupling ring. Part Number Description HD10-9-1939P-P080 Receptacle, flange mount, type II HD10-9-1939PE-P080 Receptacle, flange mount, type II, reduced wire seal HD10-9-1939P-BP03 Receptacle, panel nut mount, type II HD10-9-1939PE-BP03 Receptacle, panel nut mount, type II, reduced wire seal HD14-9-1939P-P080 Receptacle, type II HD14-9-1939PE-P080 Receptacle, type II, reduced wire seal HD16-9-1939S-P080 Plug, coupling ring, type II HD16-9-1939SE-P080 Plug, coupling ring, type II, reduced wire seal HD17-9-1939S-P080 Plug, no coupling ring (slip-on), type II HD17-9-1939SE-P080 Plug, no coupling ring (slip-on), type II, reduced wire seal 0460-202-1631 Pin, solid, size 16, gold 0460-247-1631 Pin, solid, size 16, gold, extended 0462-201-1631 Socket, solid, size 16, gold 0462-221-1631 Socket, solid, size 16, gold, extended PAGE 201 Controller Area Networks J1939/15 2 WIRE SYSTEM SCHEMATIC SAE J1939/15 defines the requirements for reduced physical layer 2-wire CAN systems consisting of an unshielded twisted pair of wires. DEUTSCH DTM 2 way connectors are offered in several modifications to meet the requirements of this standard. DTM connectors for serial data communications include “Y” receptacles, connectors with end caps and shrink boot adapters, and receptacles with molded-in 120Ω resistors for network terminations. ECU ECU N Receptacle-ADTM04-2P-**** Wedge-AWM-2P Receptacle-ADTM04-2P-**** Wedge-AWM-2P Plug-ADTM06-2S-**** Wedge-AWM-2S Plug-ADTM06-2S-**** Wedge-AWM-2S Terminating Receptacle DTM04-2P-EP10 Wedgelock Included Plug-BDTM06-2S-**** Wedge-BWM-2SB Receptacle-ADTM04-2P-**** Wedge-AWM-2P Plug-ADTM06-2S-**** Wedge-AWM-2S Receptacle-BDTM04-2P-**** Wedgelock-BWM-2PB Plug-BDTM06-2S-**** Wedge-BWM-2SB ECU N + I Receptacle-YDTM04-2P-P007 Plug-BDTM06-2S-**** Wedge-BWM-2SB +Battery Plug-BDTM06-2S-**** Wedge-BWM-2SB Terminating Receptacle DTM04-2P-EP10 Wedgelock Included INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Controller Area Networks J1939/15 DEUTSCH CONNECTOR OPTIONS Part Number Description DTM04-2P-P007 Receptacle, “y” connector DTM04-2P-E007 Receptacle, gray, shrink boot adapter DTM04-2P-P006 Receptacle, gray, 120Ω resistor DTM04-2P-EE03 Receptacle, black, shrink boot adapter DTM06-2S-E007 Plug, gray, shrink boot adapter DTM06-2S-P006 Plug, gray, 120Ω resistor DTM06-2S-EE03 Plug, black, shrink boot adapter DTM06-2S-EP10 Plug, black, 120Ω resistor WM-2P Wedgelock, orange WM-2PA Wedgelock, gray WM-2PB Wedgelock, black WM-2S Wedgelock, orange WM-2SA Wedgelock, gray WM-2SB Wedgelock, black 0460-202-2031 Pin, solid, size 20, gold 1060-20-0144 Pin, stamped & formed, size 20, gold 0462-201-2031 Socket, solid, size 20, gold 1062-20-0144 Socket, stamped & formed, size 20, gold PAGE 203 Controller Area Networks NOTES: INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Contents Diodes & Resistors Overview.............................206 Configurations..........................................................206 Diodes & Resistor Characteristics........... 207-208 DEUTSCH Diodes & Resistors Diodes & Resistors Overview DEUTSCH DT connectors with diodes and resistors are useful anywhere you need to regulate power or protect a device against a potential power surge. A diode allows current to flow in one direction only. By preventing current from traveling a circuit in the wrong direction, a diode can protect an electronic device from damage. Devices with batteries will often use diodes to prevent power from flowing in reverse if the battery is not installed correctly. A resistor limits or blocks current flow in both directions. Resistors protect sensitive electronics by limiting the amount of electricity that can flow to the device through the resistor, and therefore preventing power spikes. For example, resistors are used to prevent power surges from burning out an LED by restricting current flow to the light. DEUTSCH diode and resistor connectors are easily added to an application after the fact if unwanted power surges are discovered. DIODE & RESISTOR CONFIGURATIONS Insert Arrangement XX-XX X size XX DT SERIES CONFIGURATIONS DT0*-2*-**** 2 size 16 DT0*-3*-**** 3 size 16 DT0*-4*-**** 4 size 16 DTM SERIES CONFIGURATIONS DTM0*-2*-**** 2 size 20 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Part Number Number and Size of Cavities DEUTSCH Diodes & Resistors PART NUMBERING SYSTEM Part Number DT* 04 - 2 P - RT ** Special Modifications Series Blank DT series M Electronic Package Designator DTM series Contacts Style 04 Receptacle P Pin 06 Plug S Socket Configuration DIODE CHARACTERISTICS DT Series Avg. Forward Current Color Part Number DT04-2P-RT01 Receptacle MUR460 600 V max. 1.28 V max. 4.0 A max. Black DT04-2P-RT02 Receptacle 1N5625GP 400 V max. 1.0 V max. 3.0 A max. Black Receptacle MUR460 (3) 600 V max. 1.28 V max. 4.0 A max. Black Receptacle MUR460 (2) 600 V max. 1.28 V max. 4.0 A max. Gray DT04-4P-RT01 DT04-4P-RT03 Diode Part Peak Reverse Number Volts Peak Forward Volts Plug or Receptacle PAGE 207 DEUTSCH Diodes & Resistors RESISTOR CHARACTERISTICS DTM Series DT Series Part Number Plug or Receptacle Resistor Ohms Resistor Watts Color DTM04-2P-EP10 Receptacle 120 0.4 Black (B keyed wedgelock included) DTM04-2P-P006 Receptacle 120 0.4 Gray (A keyed wedgelock included) DTM06-2S-EP10 Plug 120 0.4 Black (B keyed wedgelock included) DTM06-2S-P006 Plug 120 0.4 Gray (A keyed wedgelock included) Part Number Plug or Receptacle Resistor Ohms Resistor Watts Color DT04-2P-RT25 Receptacle 27k 0.5 Black DT04-3P-EP10 Receptacle 120 0.4 min. Black (J1939 keyed wedgelock included) DT04-3P-P006 Receptacle 120 0.4 min. Gray (J1939 keyed wedgelock included) DT06-3S-EP10 Plug 120 0.4 min. Black (J1939 keyed wedgelock included) DT06-3S-P006 Plug 120 0.4 min. Gray (J1939 keyed wedgelock included) INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Contents Printed Circuit Board Overview..........................210 PCB Connector Options........................................210 AMPSEAL Connectors............................................ 211 Circular DIN Connectors......................................... 211 DRC Series.......................................................... 212-213 DT Family............................................................214-216 HD10 Series................................................................ 216 LEAVYSEAL................................................................ 217 STRIKE Series............................................................ 217 Superseal 1.0 Connectors...................................... 218 PCB Enclosures and Headers...................... 218-221 Printed Circuit Board Connectors Printed Circuit Board Overview Printed circuit board or PCB connectors are heavy duty environmentally sealed connectors designed for wire-to-circuit board connections. TE Connectivity Industrial & Commercial Transportation’s connectors are built to maintain the integrity and continuity of data and power signals in harsh environments. Developed and designed for heavy duty electronically equipped vehicles, TE’s printed circuit board connector bodies will withstand dust, dirt, moisture, and vibration. Available in a variety of styles from several different connector families, TE’s printed circuit board connectors cover a range of pin counts from 2 to 76 and wire gauges from 10 to 22. Many of the connectors are available in straight, 90°, or solder pot options. PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARD CONNECTOR OPTIONS Product Line Cavity Arrangements Mating Connector Wire Size 8, 14, 23, 35 16-20 AWG Circular DIN 2, 3, 4 2.50-.20 mm2 DRC Series 24, 40, 50, 60, 70, 76 14-22 AWG 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 12 14-20 AWG DTM Series 8, 12, 48 (flangeless) 16-22 AWG DTP Series 4 10-14 AWG HD10 Series 6,9 14-20 AWG LEAVYSEAL 21, 39, 62, 92 6.0-.20 mm2 32 14-22 AWG 26, 34, 60 1.25-.50 mm2 12, 24, 36, 48 (DT series headers) 14-20 AWG 12, 24 (DTM series headers) 16-22 AWG AMPSEAL DT Series STRIKE Superseal 1.0 EEC Enclosure and Flange Receptacle Notes: DT series has flangeless options. Some arrangements of the DT and DTM series are available with A, B, C, and D keying options. Note See individual product line sections for part numbering system. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Printed Circuit Board Connectors AMPSEAL CONNECTORS 90­° OR STRAIGHT Materials Cover: Glass filled PBT Wire Seal: Silicone rubber Contacts: Tin or gold plated brass 8 Positions 8 size 1.3 mm 14 Positions 14 size 1.3 mm Mating Plugs 8 Position: 776286-* 14 Position: 776273-* 23 Position: 770680-* 35 Position: 776164-* 23 Positions 23 size 1.3 mm 35 Positions 35 size 1.3 mm Note See pages 11-20 for comprehensive AMPSEAL product information. CIRCULAR DIN CONNECTORS STRAIGHT Materials Housing: Glass filled PBT & PA Flange Seal: Silicone rubber Contacts: CuZn, tin plated      CuZn, gold plated 2 Positions 2 size 2.5 mm 3 Positions 3 size 2.5 mm Mating Plugs 2 Position: 1-967325-3, 1-968968-3 (secondary locking) 3 Position: 1-967325-2, 1-968968-2 (secondary locking) 4 Position: 1-967325-1, 1-968968-1 (secondary locking) 4 Positions 4 size 2.5 mm Note See pages 35-44 for comprehensive Circular DIN product information. PAGE 211 Printed Circuit Board Connectors DRC10 SERIES STRAIGHT Materials Housing: Glass filled PA and PPS Grommet: Silicone rubber Receptacle Threaded Insert: Stainless steel/brass Contacts: Molded-in copper alloy, tin plated solder pot standard (gold optional - see modifications) DRC10-24P* 24 size 16 Mating Plugs 24 Pin: DRC16-24S* 40 Pin: DRC16-40S Modifications A004: Tin plated PCB pins AG02: Some terminals are gold plated DRC10-40P* 40 size 16 DRC13 SERIES 90° Materials Housing: Glass filled PA and PPS Receptacle Threaded Insert: Stainless steel/brass Contacts: Molded-in copper alloy, tin plated PCB pins standard (gold optional - see modifications) Mounting Seal: Silicone rubber DRC13-24P* 24 size 16 Mating Plugs 24 Pin: DRC16-24S* 40 Pin: DRC18-40S* 70 Pin: DRC16-70S* Modifications C023: 5mm2 threaded insert mounting holes G002: Only outside terminal rows are gold plated N012: One piece connector design DRC13-40P* 40 size 16 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DRC13-70P* 70 size 16 Printed Circuit Board Connectors DRC20/22 SERIES STRAIGHT Materials Housing: Glass filled PA and PPS Grommet: Silicone rubber Receptacle Threaded Insert: Stainless steel/brass Contacts: Molded-in copper alloy, gold plated mating side, tin plated PCB side (size 12 contacts are tin plated on mating and PCB sides) Mounting Seal: Silicone rubber DRC2*-50P* 50 size 20 Mating Plugs 50 Pin: DRC26-50S** 60 Pin: DRC26-60S** 76 Pin: (2) DRC26-38S** DRC22 DRC20 DRC20-60P* 60 size 20 DRC20-76P**** 68 size 20, 8 size 12 DRC23 SERIES 90° Materials Housing: Glass filled PA and PPS Grommet: Silicone rubber Receptacle Threaded Insert: Stainless steel/brass Contacts: Molded-in copper alloy, gold plated PCB pins standard (tin optional) Mounting Seal: Silicone rubber DRC2*-24** 24 size 20 Mating Plugs 24 Pin: DRC26-24S* 40 Pin: DRC26-40S* 64 Pin: DRC26-24S*, DRC26-40S* Modifications N010: Custom mount N012: One piece connector design DRC2*-64** 64 size 20 Note See pages 99-108 for comprehensive DRC series product information. DRC2*-40** 40 size 20 PAGE 213 Printed Circuit Board Connectors DT13/15 SERIES 90° OR STRAIGHT Mating Plugs 2 Pin: DT06-2S 3 Pin: DT06-3S 4 Pin: DT06-4S 6 Pin: DT06-6S 8 Pin: DT06-08S* 12 Pin: DT06-12S* Materials Housing: Glass filled PA Contacts: Molded-in copper alloy, nickel plated mating side, tin plated PCB side (gold plating optional - contact your representative) Mounting Seal: Silicone rubber DT1*-2P 2 size 16 Modifications B016: Extended shell and additional keys G003: Gold plated pins DT1*-4P 4 size 16 DT1*-6P 6 size 16 DT13 DT15 DT1*-08P* 8 size 16 A, B, C, D DT1*-12P* 12 size 16 A, B, C, D Note Camcar thread forming screws are recommended. See drawing. DTF13 SERIES FLANGELESS 90° Materials Housing: Glass filled PA Contacts: Molded-in copper alloy, tin plated PCB side (gold plating optional - contact your representative) Mating Plugs 2 Pin: DT06-2S 3 Pin: DT06-3S 4 Pin: DT06-4S 6 Pin: DT06-6S 12 Pin: DT06-12S* Modifications G003: Gold plated pins DTF13-2P 2 size 16 DTF13-3P 3 size 16 DTF13-4P 4 size 16 DTF13-6P 6 size 16 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS DTF13-12P* 12 size 16 A, B, C, D Printed Circuit Board Connectors DTF15 SERIES FLANGELESS STRAIGHT Materials Housing: Glass filled PA Contacts: Molded-in copper alloy, tin plated PCB side (gold plating optional - contact your representative) Mating Plugs 12 Pin: DT06-12S* Modifications G003: Gold plated pins DTF15-12P* 12 size 16 A, B, C, D helpful hint By fixing the connectors to the board prior to soldering, pressure can be greatly reduced at the solder joint. DTM13/15 SERIES 90° OR STRAIGHT Materials Housing: Glass filled PA Contacts: Molded-in copper alloy, tin plated PCB side (gold plating optional - contact your representative) Mounting Seal: Silicone rubber Mating Plugs 12 Pin: DTM06-12S* DTM13 DTM15 DTM1*-12P* 12 size 20 A, B, C, D Note See pages 109-132 for comprehensive DT Family product information. PAGE 215 Printed Circuit Board Connectors DTMF15 SERIES STRAIGHT Materials Housing: Glass filled PA Contacts: Molded-in copper alloy, tin plated (gold plating optional - contact your representative) Mating Plugs 12 Pin: (4) DTM06-12S* Modifications B026: Alternate keying position DTMF15-48P (4) 12 size 20 DTP10/13/15 SERIES 90° OR STRAIGHT Materials Housing: Glass filled PA Contacts: Molded-in copper alloy, tin plated Mounting Seal: Silicone rubber Mating Plugs 4 Pin: (4) DTP06-4S DTP13 DTP10 DTP1*-4P 4 size 12 HD10 SERIES STRAIGHT Materials Housing: Glass filled PA Contacts: Molded-in copper alloy, nickel plated Mounting Seal: Standard o-rings may be used HD10-6-96P-N005 6 size 16 Mating Plugs 6 Pin: HD16-6-96S 9 Pin: HD16-9-96S Modifications N005: Straight reduced diameter pins supplied as standard HD10-9-96P-N005 9 size 16 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Printed Circuit Board Connectors LEAVYSEAL CONNECTORS 90° OR STRAIGHT Materials Housing: Glass filled PBT Contacts: CuSn, silver plated 21 Positions 21 size 2.8 Mating Plugs 21 Pin: 1-1534127-1, 1-2208688-1 (V0 rated material) 39 Pin: 5-1718321-3, 5-2208684-3 (V0 rated material) 62 Pin: 1-1418883-1 (A key), 2-1418883-1 (B key) 92 Pin: 1-703998-1 (NW 26 wire exit),         3-1703998-1 (NW 29 wire exit) 39 Positions 39 size 2.8 62 Positions 56 size 1.5 6 size 2.8 Note See pages 63-78 for comprehensive LEAVYSEAL product information. 92 Positions 92 size 1.5 STRIKE13/15 SERIES 90° OR STRAIGHT Materials Housing: Glass filled PBT Contacts: Molded-in copper alloy, tin plated (gold plating optionalcontact your representative) Mating Plugs 32 Pin: SRK06-MD*-32A-001 Modifications G003: Gold plated pins SRK1*-MD*-32A-001-**** 4 Size 16 28 Size 20 Note See pages 161-168 for comprehensive STRIKE series product information. PAGE 217 Printed Circuit Board Connectors SUPERSEAL 1.0 MM CONNECTORS 90° OR STRAIGHT Materials Housing: Thermoplastic Contacts: Gold over Ni mating pins, tin-lead over Ni - soldering pins 26 Positions 26 size 1.0 mm Mating Plugs 26 Pin: 3-1437290-7 34 Pin: 4-1437290-0 60 Pin: (1) 3-1437290-7 (26P), (1) 4-1437290-0 (34P) 34 Positions 34 size 1.0 mm 60 Positions 60 size 1.0 mm Note See pages 79-84 for comprehensive Superseal 1.0 product information. Printed Circuit Board Enclosures and Headers Compact circuit board enclosures that accept snap-in headers are available. The enclosure features a through hole mounting flange on each side, as well as optional venting. Designed with space to accommodate one or more DT or DTM series interfaces, the headers feature 90° pins. A radial flange seal provides environmental sealing to the enclosure. The headers mate with the DT and DTM standard plugs. DT SERIES ENCLOSURE WITH HEADER DIMENSIONS A B C DT Series Enclosure with Header Overall Length A 7.93 (201.30) Overall Height B Overall Width C 2.15 (54.63) 6.30 (160.00) Dimensions are for reference only INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Printed Circuit Board Connectors DT SERIES HEADER CONNECTOR Materials Contacts: Molded-in tin (gold plating optional - contact your representative) DT13-12PA-**** 12 size 16 A Mating Plugs 12 Pin: DT06-12S* 24 Pin: (2) DT06-12S* 36 Pin: (3) DT06-12S* DT13-24PAB-**** (2) 12 size 16 A, B DT13-36PABC-**** (3) 12 size 16 A, B, C Modifications GR02: DT Series snap-in header with gold plated pins R015: DT Series snap-in header DT13-48PABCD-**** (4) 12 size 16 A, B, C, D Note Keying position of receptacle must match keying position of mating plug(s). DT SERIES PCB ENCLOSURE Materials Housing: Thermoplastic Board Size 5” x 6.50” Venting A: With vent hole B: Without vent hole EEC-5X650* PAGE 219 Printed Circuit Board Connectors DTM SERIES ENCLOSURE WITH HEADER DIMENSIONS A B C DTM Series Enclosure with Header Overall Length A Overall Height B Overall Width C 5.24 (133.03) 1.42 (36.00) 4.68 (118.80) Dimensions are for reference only DTM SERIES HEADER CONNECTOR Materials Contacts: Molded-in nickel mating side, tin plated PCB side Mating Plugs 12 Pin: DTM06-12S* 24 Pin: (2) DTM06-12S* Modifications GR01: DTM Series snap-in header with gold plated pins DTM13-12P*-**** 12 size 20 A, B, C, D DTM13-12PA-12PB-**** (2) 12 size 20 A, B DTM13-12PC-12PD-**** (2) 12 size 20 C, D INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Printed Circuit Board Connectors DTM SERIES PCB ENCLOSURE Materials Housing: Thermoplastic Board Size 3.25” x 4” EEC-325X4* Venting A: With vent hole B: Without vent hole Modifications E016: Molded in clear Ultem® material EEC-325X4*-E016 PAGE 221 Printed Circuit Board Connectors NOTES: INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Contents DTHD Series Overview.......................................... 224 DTHD Series Material Specifications............... 224 DTHD Series Dimensions...................................... 224 DTHD Series Ordering Information.................. 225 DTHD Special Modifications............................... 225 DTHD Series Accessories..................................... 226 Jiffy Splice Overview............................................. 227 Jiffy Splice Dimensions......................................... 227 Jiffy Splice How To Instructions............... 227-228 Single Terminal Solutions Single Terminal Overview Two different solutions are available for applications that require heavy duty single terminal connections. DEUTSCH DTHD series connectors and Jiffy Splices provide environmentally sealed field-serviceable connections for the full range of wire gauges covered by DEUTSCH contacts. DTHD connectors are heavy duty power terminations for in-line and mounted applications. Jiffy Splices are lightweight in-line splices for quick connections. Both options provide easy installation and service with standard tools and contacts. DTHD SERIES OVERVIEW DTHD connectors are single terminal connectors for heavy duty applications. Easy to install, environmentally sealed and compact in size, they are a simple, field serviceable alternative to a splice. DTHD connectors are available in three sizes, carry 25 to 100 amps, and can be mounted or used in-line. MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS Grommet: Silicone rubber Shell: Unfilled PEI DIMENSIONS F B E A C DTHD Plug Contact Overall Length Size A D DTHD Receptacle Overall Height B Overall Width C Overall Length D Overall Height E Overall Width F 12 1.498 (38.05) .771 (19.58) .570 (14.48) 2.068 (52.53) .850 (21.59) .710 (18.08) 8 1.498 (38.05) .861 (21.87) .660 (16.76) 2.068 (52.53) .940 (23.88) .800 (20.32) 4 1.498 (38.05) 1.076 (27.33) .875 (22.23) 2.068 (52.53) 1.170 (29.72) 1.045 (26.54) Dimensions are for reference only. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Single Terminal Solutions DTHD SERIES PART NUMBERING SYSTEM Part Number DTHD 06 - 1 - 4 S - **** Series Special Modifications Style Contacts 04 Receptacle P Pin 06 Plug S Socket Single Terminal Contact Size 4 8 12 ORDERING INFORMATION Here are some of the common part numbers in the DTHD series. Several additional connectors may be available. Position 1 Contact Size Plug Receptacle 12 DTHD06-1-12S DTHD04-1-12P 8 DTHD06-1-8S DTHD04-1-8P 4 DTHD06-1-4S DTHD04-1-4P Special Modifications DTHD series connectors offer modifications to enhance the design flexibility and meet application specific needs. Options include end caps and flanges. E003 MODIFICATION The E003 is an end cap modification. The end cap is a protective cap that is sonically welded to the rear of the connector. L013 & L009 MODIFICATION The L013 and L009 are sealed flange modifications. The L013 offers outside mounting and the L009 offers inside mounting. L009 L013 PAGE 225 Single Terminal Solutions Accessories There is a full line of mounting clips available for use with the DTHD series. The mounting clips offer straight or side mounting and several material options. The mounting clips are designed to be used on all DTHD receptacles. Mounting Direction Color/Material Hole O.D. inches (mm) 1027-003-1200 Straight Stainless steel .433 (11.0) 1027-005-1200 Straight Stainless steel .512 (13.0) 1027-004-1200 Straight Steel w/ zinc plating .512 (13.0) 1027-008-1200 Side Steel w/ zinc plating .433 (11.0) 1027-013-1200/ 1027-017-1200 Side Steel w/ zinc plating .323 (8.2) 1011-026-0205 Straight Gray plastic .200 (5.08) 1011-030-0205 Straight Black plastic - Straight Black plastic - Part Number 1011-310-0205* *Connector removeable with 50N of force INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Single Terminal Solutions ut LAD D l u si v e t ion xc o E JIFFY SPLICE OVERVIEW D i s t ri b DEUTSCH Jiffy Splices are a unique, field-serviceable alternative to permanent splices. Made from the same high quality silicone elastomer as DEUTSCH connector seals and grommets, the Jiffy Splice body houses a contact retention system that secures a mated pair of contacts in a compact environmentally sealed unit. Jiffy Splices are easy to install and service. B Dia. A Part Number Hole O.D. inches (mm) Size A B (min.) Wire AWG JS-04-00 4 3.437 (87.30) .765 (19.43) 6 .280-.292 (7.11-7.42) JS-12-00 12 2.500 (63.50) .500 (12.70) 12-14 .134-.170 (3.40-4.32) JS-16-00 16 2.465 (62.61) .385 (9.78) 14-20 .100-.134 (2.54-3.40) Dimensions are for reference only Note Jiffy Splices accept one pin and one socket. How To Instructions CONTACT INSERTION Step 1: Grasp contact approximately one inch behind the contact crimp barrel. Step 2: Hold Jiffy Splice between thumb and forefinger approximately one half inch behind cavity. Step 3: Push contact straight into Jiffy Splice until a positive stop is felt. An audible “snap” will occur when correctly mated. A light tug will confirm it is properly seated. PAGE 227 Single Terminal Solutions CONTACT REMOVAL Step 1: Snap appropriate size removal tool over the wire. Step 2: Hold Jiffy Splice between thumb and forefinger approximately one half inch behind cavity. Slide tool into cavity until resistance is felt and retaining fingers are engaged. Do not twist or insert tool at an angle. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Step 3: Grip Jiffy Splice between thumb and forefinger and slowly pull contact wire assembly with removal tool out of cavity. Contents DEUTSCH Modification List...................... 230-238 Other TE Industrial & Commercial Transportation Products............................. 239-240 Requirements & Standards................................... 241 Glossary............................................................. 242-247 Index....................................................................248-251 Additional Resources Modification List The modification list is only applicable to the DEUTSCH product line and series listed. Modifications listed are for reference only and may not be available for every arrangement. Mod # Series Description A A004 DRC Receptacle with molded-in PCB pins, 24 and 40 way A006 DRC Receptacle with molded-in PCB pins, 40 way, #40 pin removed B009 HD10 Receptacle with raised key removed from front of flange, no rear threads B010 HD10 Plug with coupling ring added B016 DT, DT13/15 B019 HD30 Custom snap ring mount B022 HD10 Receptacle with D-hole panel mount, rear threads, J1939, black B025 HD10 Receptacle with D-hole panel mount, no rear threads, black B026 DTMF PCB receptacle with alternate keying, requires plugs with WM-12S-B026 wedgelocks B028 DT15 5 P.S.I rating B Receptacle has extended shell and enhanced keys, plug has enhanced seal retention (P012), 12 way BE BE02 DT Receptacle with extended shell and enhanced keys (B016), end cap BE03 DT Receptacle with extended shell and enhanced keys (B016), end cap, black BE04 DT Receptacle with extended shell and enhanced keys (B016), end cap, reduced diameter seals (E seal), black BE05 DT Receptacle with extended shell and enhanced keys (B016), end cap, sealed flange, reduced diameter seals (E seal), threaded stainless steel flange inserts BL04 DT Receptacle with extended shell and enhanced keys (B016), welded flange BL08 DT Receptacle with extended shell and enhanced keys (B016), welded flange, black BL INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Additional Resources Mod # Series Description BL10 DT Receptacle with extended shell and enhanced keys (B016), sealed flange, reduced diameter seals (E seal), shrink boot adapter, threaded stainless steel flange inserts BL11 DT Receptacle with extended shell and enhanced keys (B016), sealed flange, reduced diameter seals (E seal), end cap, threaded stainless steel flange inserts BP BP03 HD10 Receptacle with D-hole panel mount, J1939 Type II, green C003 HDN Standard cavity marking identification C008 DT C012 HD30 C015 DT, DTP C016 HD10 C017 DT, DTM, DTP C018 HD30 Cavities blocked (11, 18, 19), N/E seal options C019 HD30 Cavities blocked (1, 2, 8, 9), N/E seal options C020 HD30 Cavities blocked (A, D), N/E seal options C021 HD30 Cavities blocked (A, B, C, D) C022 HD30 Cavities blocked (A, D, J, M), with reduced diameter seals (E seal) C024 HD10 Cavities blocked (B, C, D) C026 DRC Cavities blocked, 50 way C030 HD30, HDP20 Four size 16 cavities blocked (1, 2, 5, 6) C038 HD30, HDP20 Three size 4, four size 16, requires special size 4 AWG contacts C041 HDP20 C Cavity blocked (C) Cavities blocked (J, P) Reduced diameter seals (E seal) Cavities blocked (H, J) - HD10 Series 9 way Solid rear grommet Receptacle with diagnostic keying CE CE01 DT Reduced diameter seals (E seal), end cap CE02 DT, DTP CE03 DT Reduced diameter seals (E seal), end cap, black CE04 DT Reduced diameter seals (E seal), shrink boot adapter Reduced diameter seals (E seal), black PAGE 231 Additional Resources Mod # Series Description CE05 DT Plug with reduced diameter seals (E seal), enhanced seal retention (P012), end cap CE06 DT Plug with reduced diameter seals (E seal), enhanced seal retention (P012) CE07 DT Receptacle with extended shell and enhanced keys (B016), reduced diameter seals (E seal), end cap CE08 DT Receptacle with extended shell and enhanced keys (B016), reduced diameter seals (E seal) CE09 DT Reduced diameter seals (E seal), shrink boot adapter, black CE10 DT Plug with reduced diameter seals (E seal), enhanced seal retention (P012), black CE11 DT Plug with reduced diameter seals (E seal), enhanced seal retention (P012), end cap, black CE12 DT Plug with reduced diameter seals (E seal), enhanced seal retention (P012), shrink boot adapter, black CE13 DT Plug with reduced diameter seals (E seal), enhanced seal retention (P012), shrink boot adapter CE14 DT Plug with reduced diameter seals (E seal), enhanced seal retention (P012), latch guard end cap, black CE27 DT Plug with reduced diameter seals (E seal), enhanced seal retention (P012), for use with integrated LED wedgelock, end cap, transparent Ultem CE28 DT Plug with reduced diameter seals (E seal), enhanced seal retention (P012), for use with integrated LED wedgelock, transparent Ultem CL CL01 HD30 Cavities blocked (J, Q, R, S, X), adapter for cable clamp (072) CL03 DT Reduced diameter seals (E seal), welded flange CL07 DT Reduced diameter seals (E seal), sealed flange, shrink boot adapter CL08 DT Reduced diameter seals (E seal), welded flange, end cap, disabled latch CL09 DT Reduced diameter seals (E seal), sealed flange, end cap, black CL15 DT Reduced diameter seals (E seal), welded flange, black CL20 HDP20 Plug with diagnostic keying CG CG01 DRC 5mm threaded insert with silver plating, molded-in contacts, outside rows gold INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Additional Resources Mod # Series Description CP CP01 DT All cavities plugged, enhanced seal retention (P012), end cap E E003 DT, DTHD, DTM, DTP End cap E004 DT, DTM, DTP, HD10 Black E005 DT, DTM, DTP E007 DTM Shrink boot adapter E008 DT Shrink boot adapter E009 DRC 24 way and 40 way receptacle, B keys, housing is gray, flange is black E016 EEC Standard EEC box, molded-in transparent Ultem material E019 AEC Backshell adapter Black, end cap EE EE01 DT Shrink boot adapter, black EE03 DTM Shrink boot adapter, black EE04 DTM High temp, black EE05 DT High temp, enhanced seal retention (P012) on plug, end cap, black EF01 DT Fluorosilicone front seals, end cap EF02 DT Fluorosilicone front seals, latch guard end cap DT Plug, 18 cavity DT with 18 size 16 contacts, enhanced seal retention (P012), end cap, “A” key is gray, “B” key is black, “C” key is green, “D” key is brown EP04 DT End cap (same as E003 mod) EP05 DT Latch guard end cap EF EK EK02 EP PAGE 233 Additional Resources Mod # Series Description EP06 DT Plug with enhanced seal retention (P012), end cap EP07 DT Plug with enhanced seal retention (P012), black EP08 DT Plug with enhanced seal retention (P012), end cap, black EP09 DT Plug with enhanced seal retention (P012), latch guard end cap, black EP10 DT, DTM EP11 DT Plug with enhanced seal retention (P012), shrink boot adapter, black EP12 DT Bussed receptacle, 4 and 6 way only, 1 buss, black, gold plated pins EP13 DT Bussed receptacle, 4 and 6 way only, 1 buss, black, nickel plated pins EP14 DT Bussed receptacle, 6 way, 2 busses, black, nickel plated pins EP20 DT Plug with enhanced seal retention (P012), shrink boot adapter 120 ohm terminating resistor (J1939), black F F001 HDN Inserts within connector made of Ultem G001 DRC Gold plated pins G002 DRC Outside rows of pins are gold plated and rest are tin plated G003 DT13/15 G004 DRC G005 DRCP Tin plated signal pins, tin plated power pins GC03 DRCP Gold plated signal pins, depopulated power pins GC05 DRCP Tin plated signal pins, depopulated power pins G Gold plated pins Interface side pins are nickel plated, PCB side pins are tin plated GC GR GR01 DTM13 (EEC headers) Snap-in DTM PCB mounted header for DTM EEC enclosure, 12 and 24 pins, gold plated pins H H001 HD30 Plated with yellow chromate conversion INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Additional Resources Mod # Series Description HL HL01 HD30 Dust cap plated with yellow chromate conversion, sash chain with eyelet for #10 screw HL02 HD30 Adapter for cable clamp (-072) plated with yellow chromate conversion J001 HD30 Reverse cavity marking identification on grommet J059 HD30 Reverse cavity marking identification on grommet, cable clamp (-059) J K K001 AEC Molded-in shell marking, remove blue stripe, end cap K003 DT16 Plug, 15 cavity DT with two size 12 contacts and 13 size 16 contacts, enhanced seal retention (P012), end cap, black K004 DT16 Plug, 18 cavity DT with 18 size 16 contacts, enhanced seal retention (P012), end cap, black DT16 Plug, six cavity DT with six size 16 contacts, enhanced seal retention (P012), end cap, green L001 HD30 Same as -059 (cable clamp) L003 HD30 Cable clamp adapter (-072) L005 HD30 Cable clamp adapter (-072) without drain holes L006 HD30 -059 modification using adapter without drain holes L009 DTHD Sealed flange, inside mount KP KP01 L L011 DRC Wire router L012 DT, DTP, DTM L013 DTHD L015 HDP20 Threaded adapter for backshell strain relief L017 HDP20 Ring adapter for backshell strain relief L018 DRB L020 HD30, HD50 Welded flange Sealed flange, outside mount Wire router Removes #10 eyelet from the dust cap chain PAGE 235 Additional Resources Mod # Series L024 HDP20 L072 HD30 Description Wide threaded adapter for backshell strain relief Adapter ring LE LE01 DT Sealed flange, inside mount, gasket, end cap LE03 DT Sealed flange, outside mount, o-ring sold separately, end cap, NOTE: DT04-08PA-LE03 comes with shrink boot adapter and o-ring on flange LE05 DT Sealed flange, inside mount, gasket, end cap LE06 DT Sealed flange, inside mount, reduced diameter seals (E seal), end cap LE07 DT, DTP LE08 DT Welded flange, shrink boot adapter, gray LE09 DT Sealed flange, o-ring, end cap, black LE10 DT Sealed flange, inside mount, gasket, end cap, black LE11 DT Welded flange, end cap, black LE12 DT Welded flange, shrink boot adapter, black LE13 DT Special adapter, round housing, end cap LE14 DT Welded flange, black LE17 DT Receptacle with extended shell and enhanced keys (B016), sealed flange, gasket sold separately, end cap, black LE21 DT Receptacle with extended shell and enhanced keys (B016), sealed flange, reduced diameter seals (E seal), end cap, one piece connector design, threaded stainless steel flange inserts Welded flange, end cap N N005 HD10 Receptacle with molded-in PCB pins, modified shell N006 DT Receptacle with 90° molded-in contacts N012 DRC Receptacle, one piece connector design P005 AEC Special oversized seal on AEC Series plugs and dust caps P006 DT, DTM 120 ohm terminating resistor (J1939) P007 DT, DTM Receptacle “Y” connector (J1939) P INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Additional Resources Mod # Series Description Plug with enhanced seal retention, 2-6 way are black, 8 and 12 way “A” key is gray, “B” key is black, “C” key is green, “D” key is brown P012 DT P013 DRC P016 DT P017 DRC Stainless steel retention clip for jackscrew P018 DTP Receptacle with 12 AWG wires attached P019 DRC Zinc chromate retention clip for jackscrew P021 DT Bussed receptacle, 6, 8, and 12 way, one buss, nickel plated pins P026 DT Bussed receptacle, 8 and 12 way, two busses, nickel plated pins P027 DT Bussed receptacle, 12 way, two busses, gold plated pins P028 DT Bussed receptacle, 8 way, two busses, nickel plated pins P030 DT Bussed receptacle, 12 way, four busses, nickel plated pins P031 DT Bussed receptacle, 12 way, four busses, gold plated pins P032 DT Integrated shrink boot adapter (J1939), black P060 DT Bussed receptacle, 2 way, one buss, nickel plated pins P064 HD30, HDP20 P075 DT P080 HD10 Plug with bonded front seal, silicone adhesive Bussed receptacle, 12 way, gold plated contacts 24-91 arrangement without internal jumper Bussed receptacle, 12 way, three busses, nickel plated pins J1939 Type II, green PE PE01 DT Latch guard, 120 ohm terminating resistor (J1939) DT Plug with enhanced seal retention (P012), 120 ohm terminating resistor (J1939), end cap, black PP PP01 R R004 DTM13 Custom enclosure header, 90° pins R005 DTM13 Custom flange, 90° pins R008 DTM13 (EEC headers) Snap-in DTM PCB mounted header for DTM EEC enclosure, 12 and 24 pins PAGE 237 Additional Resources Mod # R015 Series DT13 (EEC headers) Description Snap-in DT PCB mounted header for DT EEC enclosure, 12, 24, 36, and 48 pins RT RT01 DT Receptacle with MUR 460 diode RT02 DT Receptacle with 1N5625GP diode RT03 DT Receptacle with MUR 460 diode, 4 way available RT06 DT Receptacle with Phillips T.V.S diode 1.5KE130CA, green RT25 DT Receptacle with 27k ohm resistor, black #’s 059 HD30 Addition of threaded adapter and cable clamp assembly 072 HD30 Addition of threaded adapter 1E HD30 Removes rivet and chain from protective dust cap INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Additional Resources We go to extremes to make every connection count TE Industrial & Commercial Transportation has a product series for every harsh environment. Our timetested, high vibration resistant products and technologies provide the right solution for your applications and requirements. In addition to our terminals and connectors, our product portfolio extends to offer sensors, cylinder head wiring, hybrid & electric mobility solutions, relays, and lighting. SENSORS TE’s broad portfolio of sensor technologies is designed for a wide range of applications. TE’s sensors perform under the extreme temperature, vibration, shock, durability and performance profiles required by heavy duty on- and off-highway vehicles. Sensors for engine management, aftertreatment systems, transmissions, vehicle control and management, and cabin and occupant safety are available. CYLINDER HEAD WIRING TE offers a full-range of cable products and pass-through connectors for cylinder head wiring that deliver highly integrated systems in harsh environment applications. TE’s cylinder head wiring solutions are suitable for heavy duty diesel motors, common rail engines, pump nozzle engines, harness sytem undervalve cover for injector, and sensor to cylinder head exit connections. HYBRID & ELECTRIC MOBILITY SOLUTIONS TE has combined experience in the transportation and high-voltage industries to create safe, reliable, efficient solutions for hybrid and electric vehicles. Our solutions include AK 4.3.3, LV215-1 compliant connections and headers for electric vehicles. Also, by utilizing an integrated internal HVIL that optimizes package size and plug and header selections, multiple wire harness assembly routing options are created. PAGE 239 Additional Resources RELAYS TE Connectivity’s 24V relay product line includes a broad range of robust and versatile relays for many diverse applications within trucks, buses, tractors, construction equipment, and other heavy duty vehicles. With increased contact gaps and other key design features, these relays are designed for use in challenging environments where they may regularly encounter extended periods of shock and vibration. LIGHTING Lighting helps to better define space perception and functionality, which increases vehicle safety and human machine interface (HMI). TE offers high-performance, customized solutions for interior and exterior vehicle lighting. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Additional Resources Requirements & Standards IMDS The International Material Data System (IMDS) is a collective, computer-based material data system developed as a collaborative effort by large automotive OEMs to manage environmentally relevant aspects of parts used in vehicles. It has been adopted as the global standard for reporting material content in the automotive industry. TE Connectivity recognizes IMDS and will work with customers that use the system. IP Rating The IP Rating system is a way of classifying the degree of protection provided against the intrusion of solid objects, dust, and water in electrical enclosures. The 6 in IP 67 means that the connectors have to be completely sealed from fine dust. The 7 in IP 67 means that the connector needs to be protected from the effects of a one meter submersion. AMPSEAL, AMPSEAL 16, HDSCS, and LEAVYSEAL connectors are IP 67 rated. DEUTSCH connectors are rated IP 68. The 8 in IP 68 means that the connector needs to be protected from the effects of immersion in water under pressure for long periods. IP6K9K IP6K9K is similar to the standard IP Ratings, but is commonly referred to as a pressure washing specification. The letter K is used after the numbers to denote special testing. The 6K means the connectors need to be completely sealed from fine dust. The 9K means the connector needs to be protected from the penetrating effects of water used for high pressure/steam jet cleaning purposes. Several DEUTSCH connectors in the DT, DTM, DRC, and DRB series have been through independent lab testing and pass IP6K9K, as well as AMPSEAL connectors. HDSCS and LEAVYSEAL connectors used with the appropriate accessories meet the IP6K9K standard. J1939/11, J1939/13, and J1939/15 See CAN section. J2030 J2030 is an SAE standard for connectors between two cables or between a cable and an electrical component. The standard primarily focuses on the connectors used to mate to the electrical component. J2030 also provides environmental test and acceptance criteria for connectors used in DC electrical systems of 50 V or less in heavy duty applications typically used in offhighway equipment. Severe applications may require more rigid test levels, or field-testing on the intended application. AMPSEAL 16 connectors meet the SAE J2030 standard. RoHS The Restriction of Hazardous Substances (RoHS) in electrical and electronic equipment is a European directive. The directive restricts the use of lead, mercury, cadmium, hexavalent chromium, polybrominated biphenyls, and polybrominated diphenyl ether in new electrical and electronic components. To verify individual product compliance, please visit http://www. te.com/commerce/alt/product-compliance.do. UL Recognized A UL Recognized Component is one that is to be installed within a larger assembly by a manufacturer, and this larger assembly is then expected to be tested by UL to become UL LISTED. AMPSEAL, AMPSEAL 16, and many DEUTSCH connectors are UL Recognized Components. DEUTSCH connectors that are UL Recognized Components include the AEC, DRC, DT, DTM, DTP, HD10, and HDP20 series. Not every variation and/or modification within a DEUTSCH series may be UL Recognized Components. AMPSEAL connectors are UL 94 V0 rated. LEAVYSEAL and HDSCS products constructed with a UL 94 V0 rated material are available. For additional information, visit www.ul.com. PAGE 241 Glossary AWG (American Wire Gauge): Standardized system of wire diameter measurement. Commonly referred to as wire gauge. (Reference: National Bureau of Standards, Copper Wire Table [Handbook 100] AVS.) Adapter: Device attached to a connector to allow connection to a second device that it would not otherwise be able to attach. Ambient Temperature: The temperature of a medium (gas or liquid) surrounding an object. Ampere (amp): The unit of current. One ampere is the current flowing through one ohm of resistance at one volt potential. ARC Resistance: Time required for an electrical current to render the surface of a material conductive due to carbonization by the arc flame. Or, the time required for an arc to establish a conductive path in a material. Breakaway: Connector with a slotted coupling ring. Coupling ring is intended to fragment and allow connectors to separate without damage to the implement in the event of an unintended pull-away. Boot: Attachment for the back of a connector. Boots are typically flexible, made from plastic or plastisol, and may provide wire strain relief, environmental protection, and/or improved aesthetics. Bulkhead: Dividing wall or partition. Bulkhead connectors are designed to be mounted to a dividing wall through a cutout. Buss (also bussbar, bus or busbar): A thin conductive strip connecting multiple contacts within the body of a connector. Used to distribute electrical current to the branches of a circuit. Cable Clamp: An attachment to provide support and strain relief to the wire bundle where it exits the connector. Applicator: Tooling used in automatic machines to crimp stamped & formed contacts. Cavity: Hole in the connector grommet and housing, into which the contact must fit. Backshell: A secondary attachment for the rear of a connector to provide strain relief, environmental protection, and/or improved aesthetics. Cold Heading: Process by which contacts are formed from individual pieces of metal using dies and punches. Barrel: (1) Conductor Barrel: the section of the terminal, splice, or contact that accommodates the stripped wire. (2) Insulation Barrel: the section of the terminal, splice, or contact that accommodates the unstripped wire. Compression Nut: Secondary backshell assembly. Threads onto rear of backshell to compact the wire bundle and provide additional support. Barrel Chamfer: Beveled entry at mating end of the socket contact. Reduces contact mating force for easier connector mating. Blocked Cavities: Unused holes or contact positions in a connector which have been filled with sealing plugs or made inaccessible by modification to the rear grommet. Conductivity: The capability of a material to carry an electrical current. Conductor: Any material capable of carrying an electrical charge easily. The most common materials for wire and cable applications are aluminum and copper (bare or coated). Connector Position Assurance (CPA): A locking mechanism on the connector that prevents the mated connectors from accidental unmating. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Glossary Contact: Conductive device crimped or soldered onto the end of conductor wire to allow the transfer of electricity or data to a second conductor. Contacts are most frequently used in multiples in connectors. Also commonly referred to as terminals, pins and/or sockets. Contact, Crimp: Wire termination engineered to be permanently applied to conductor wire end with pressure. Does not use solder or heat. Contact, Insertable/Removable: Wire termination that can be mechanically joined to or removed from the connector body. Contact, Pin: Wire termination with solid mating end. Provides connection by insertion into a female or socket contact. Also referred to as male contact. Contact, Receptacle: Wire termination with hollow mating end into which the pin or male terminal is inserted. Also referred to as a female contact. Contact, Socket: Wire termination with hollow mating end into which the pin or male terminal is inserted. Also referred to as a female contact. Contact, Solder: Wire termination joined to the wire conductor with a metal joining compound. Contacts intended for solder will typically have a cup, hollow-cylinder eyelet or hook to accept a conductor and retain the applied solder. Contact Area: The area where two conductors, a wire termination and a conductor, or two wire terminations touch, permitting the flow of electricity. Contact Arrangement: The number, spacing, and organization of cavities in a connector. Contact Rating: The maximum recommended amperage to be passed through a wire terminal. Contact Resistance: The measurement of opposition to electrical flow through a pair of mated wire terminations. Resistance may be measured in ohms or in millivolt drop at a specified current over the mated terminals. Contact Retention: The axial load in either direction that a terminal can withstand without being dislodged from its correct position in the connector. Contact Shoulder: A small flange or collar on a terminal that limits the contact’s travel into or removal from the connector. Contact Size: Overall size of barrel determined by size of wire it will accept. Controller Area Network (CAN): Multiplex data systems. Multiplexing allows multiple data signals to travel on the same wires, integrating separate electronic systems and applications to a single point control and monitoring system. SAE J1939/11, J1939/13, and J1939/15 are specific types of controller area networks. Corrosion Resistance: The ability of a substance to withstand corrosion. Coupling Ring: Attached cylindrical ring used to lock mated connectors together. Crimping: To mechanically secure a terminal or splice to a conductor by use of pressure. Crimping Die: The part of a crimping tool that physically compresses the contact barrel and shapes the crimp. Crimp Tool: Implement that permanently attaches a contact to a wire using pressure. Current (I): The rate of transfer of electricity usually expressed in amperes. Current Rating: The maximum continuous electrical flow of a current recommended for a given wire situation. Expressed in amperes. Dielectric Strength: The voltage which an insulating material can withstand before breakdown occurs, usually expressed as a voltage gradient (such as volts/ mil). PAGE 243 Glossary Dielectric Test: A test in which a voltage higher than the rated voltage is applied for a specific time to determine the adequacy of the insulation under normal conditions. Dielectric Withstanding Voltage: The amount of leakage current that flows through the insulation. Diode: Electronic component that allows electrical flow in one direction only. Direct Current: An electrical current that flows in one direction only. Dust Cover: Cap used to protect and conceal the interface of an unmated connector. “E” Seal: Reduced diameter insert cavity in the rear grommet. Creates a proper seal with smaller than standard wire or insulation. Also referred to as extra thin or European seal. “E” seals are smaller than “N” and “T” seals. End Cap: A protective cover integral to, or sonically welded onto the rear of a connector. Engaging and Separating Force: Measured pull required to mate or unmate contacts or connectors. Enhanced Key: Additional indexing or polarization to help prevent mis-mating. Enhanced Seal Retention: Modification to the plug, front seal, and wedgelock to help prevent the seal from separating from the connector during unmating. Environmentally Sealed: Maintains functionality when exposed to environmental elements. Extraction Tool: An implement for removing contacts from a connector. Flange: A flat, perpendicular extension of the connector body. Flanges are used for mounting and are typically found on receptacles. Flange Seal: Elastomeric silicone seal used between flange and mounting surface to prevent leakage around the mounting cutout. Front Seal: Elastomeric silicone seal or o-ring on the mating face of a connector. The front seal is also referred to as an interfacial seal and is usually found on the plug. Grommet: Rubber or elastomeric seal. On connectors the grommet is on the rear or cable end of the connector and has the cavities through which the contact is inserted into the connector body. Ground: A conducting connection between an electrical circuit and the earth or other large conducting body to serve as an earth thus making a complete electrical circuit. Header: Flanged connector designed for wire to printed circuit board applications. Heat Seal: In cabling, a method of sealing a tape wrap jacket by means of thermal fusion. Heat Shrink: Type of tubing that shrinks to form a tight bond when heated. Indenter: The part of a crimp tool or die that compresses the contact barrel onto the conductor. In-line: Connectors that are not intended for use in mounted or PCB applications. Insertion Tool: A device used to guide contacts into proper position within a connector. Inspection Hole: An opening in a barrel contact to allow visual inspection of the conductor to verify that it has been inserted to the right depth. Insulation Resistance: The measure of resistance offered by insulation material to the flow of current. Insulation: A material having high resistance to the flow of electric current. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Glossary Insulation Crimp: (1) The physical deformation of the insulation sleeve covering a terminal or splice and the adjacent conductor insulation to hold the sleeve in place; (2) Shape combination of insulation sleeve to terminal or splice and conductor insulation after crimping. Insulation Resistance: That property of an insulating material which resists electrical current flow through the insulating material when a potential difference is applied. Millimeters Squared or mm2: Unit of measure for European Wire Size Standards (ref. DIN 72551-6 and ISO 6722-3). Moisture Resistance: Amount of water (in any form) that a properly wired and mated connection will withstand without loss of electronic qualities or leakage. Mounting Bracket: A rectangular metal device used to attach or mount connectors in an application. Insulation Support: The portion of the contact barrel enclosing but not crimped to the conductor insulation. Mounting Clip: A plastic or metal piece that attaches to a non-flanged connector to allow surface mounting. Interface: The surfaces of a mating pair of connectors that face each other when connected. “N” Seal: Normal wire seal diameter. Interfacial Seal: A seal at the mating edge of the connector to prevent ingress of moisture or contaminants when a connector is properly mated. Internal Seal: Waterproof form, typically made of silicone elastomer, that is inside the body of the connector. Provides moisture and fluid resistance when connectors are properly mated. IP Rating: A way of classifying the degree of protection provided against the intrusion of solid objects, dust, and water in electrical enclosures. Jacket: An outer nonmetallic protective covering applied over an insulated wire or cable. Key: Unique pattern of corresponding notches and projections on a set of mating connectors. The projections are intended to match the notches and prevent mis-mating. Keying Pin: Solid plastic rod designed to be inserted into an empty socket cavity to help prevent mis-mating. Locator: A device in a crimp tool to help provide proper contact position during crimping. Neoprene: Thermosetting material, chemically known as polychloroprene, with excellent flame retarding and abrasion resisting qualities. Nest: The part of a crimping die that supports the barrel during crimping. Newton (N): A unit of force which is based on the metric system. It is the force that produces an acceleration of 1 meter per second per second when exerted on a mass of 1 kilogram. O-ring: Circular seal found around the inside diameter of a receptacle: typically made from elastomeric or silicone material. Provides an environmental seal. Oxidation: The process of uniting a compound with oxygen, usually resulting in an unwanted surface degradation of the material or compound. Panel Nut: A hexagonal threaded plastic or metal ring. Along with a lockwasher, a panel nut is used for mounting. Partial Strip: A quantity less than a standard full reel of stamped & formed contacts. PCB (Printed Circuit Board) Mount: Connectors designed for wire to printed circuit board applications. Lockwasher: Thin metal ring used between the panel nut and mounting surface to create spring force to confirm a tight fitting mount. PAGE 245 Glossary Peak Voltage: The maximum instantaneous voltage. Retaining Bolt: Screw used to draw and hold mating connectors together. Pin Housing (Cap): One half of a mated pair of connectors. AMPSEAL 16 pin housings mate with a receptacle contact housing (plug) and house pin contacts. Retaining Sleeve: Lining sheath that fits into receptacle body to maintain internal seal and provide keying. Plating: Thin overlay coating of metal on contacts or components. Can be used to improve conductivity, provide for easy soldering, and prevent corrosion. Reverse Arrangement: Non-standard cavity/contact assignment (eg. Plug connectors that require pin contacts, and receptacles that require socket contacts). Plug: One half of a mated pair of connectors. Plugs typically have the locking mechanism for the mated pair, usually house the sockets, and mate with a receptacle. Ring Adapter (HDP20): Cylindrical rim or collar attached to the rear of a connector to allow the attachment of backshells or strain relief. Pre-Tinned: Solder applied to the contact and/or conductor prior to soldering. Primary Latch Reinforcement (PLR): Locking mechanism that snaps into place on the mating face of a connector after the connector is populated. A PLR holds contacts in correct alignment for mating and prevents them from being removed. Pull-Out Force: Measured energy required to separate a conductor from a contact, or a contact from a termination assembly. Ratchet Control: A crimping device that helps provide a full crimping cycle by allowing motion in only one direction until contact is fully crimped. Receptacle: One half of a mated pair of connectors. Receptacles mate with a plug and usually house pins. Receptacle Housing (Plug): One half of a mated pair of connectors. AMPSEAL and AMPSEAL 16 plugs typically have the locking mechanism for the mated pair, house the receptacle contacts, and mate with a pin housing (cap) or header. Reduced Diameter Seal: Smaller than standard holes in the connector grommet. Removal Tool: Device to disengage contacts from connector body. Sealed Flange: A flange that is molded or tooled as an integral part of the connector body to help prevent leakage at the mounting site. Sealing Plug: A non-conductive dummy pin inserted to fill an open cavity in a connector. Sealing plugs are required to maintain the integrity of the environmental seal. Seamless Terminal or Splice: Terminal or splice conductor barrel made from a single piece of metal, finished without lines or grooves that would typically appear where metal is joined to metal. Secondary Lock: Device inserted into or onto the connector interface to position and hold contacts in correct alignment. Secondary locks are called wedgelocks or terminal position assurance. Self-Extinguishing: The characteristic of a material whose flame is extinguished after the igniting flame is removed. Selective Plating: Application of a thin coating of a finish metal to specific parts of a contact, but not to others. If selective plating is used, plating is typically applied to the mating surface to provide better conductivity and reduce wear and corrosion. Shells: Outside case into which the insert and contacts are assembled. Shells of mating connectors usually also provide proper alignment and protection of projecting contacts. Also known as housing or body. INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Glossary Shield: A metallic layer, commonly aluminum or copper, of tape, braid or spiral wrapped wire construction. Its primary purpose is to prevent electrostatic or electromagnetic interference between adjacent wires and external sources. Shielded Cable: A cable in which the insulated conductor or conductors is/are enclosed in a conducting envelope or envelopes. Constructed so that essentially every point on the surface of the insulation is at ground potential or at some predetermined potential with respect to ground. Shrink Boot Adapter: Thermoplastic rear adapter designed to provide a lip for heat shrink to form around to attach it securely to a connector. Signal: An electric current used to convey information either digital, analog, audio or video. Sleeving: A braided, knitted or woven tube. Swedge: A cold-forging process to press-fit or force two metal forms into one. “T” Seal: Reduced diameter insert cavity in the rear grommet. Also referred to as thin seal, a “T” seal allows for the use of smaller wire or thinner insulation diameter. A “T” seal is larger than an “E” seal and smaller than an “N” seal. Temperature Coefficient of Resistivity: The change in resistance per degree of change in temperature. Terminal: A device designed to attach to the end of a conductor wire to allow it to connect to another conductor wire and allow electrical current to pass between them. Also commonly referred to as a contact. UL Recognized Component: One that is to be installed within a larger assembly by a manufacturer, and this larger assembly is then expected to be tested by UL to become UL Listed. Splice: A connection of two or more conductors or cables to provide good mechanical strength as well as good conductivity. Socket Contact Sleeve: A cylindrical, protective encasement for the contact fingers or a contact spring. The socket contact sleeve holds the inner mechanism of the contact in place and provides a smooth exterior surface. Solderless Connection: Joint between two metals created by pressure without the use of metallic alloy compounds or heat. Solid Contact: Closed barrel terminal manufactured using a cold heading process. Stamped & Formed Contact: Open barrel terminal manufactured using a precision stamping process. Strain Relief: Hard plastic or metal device that attaches to the rear of a connector to provide wire support. Strand: A single filament of uninsulated wire. Strip: To remove insulation from a conductor. PAGE 247 Index Topic Page Topic Page A Crimp sleeve reducer........................................................... 177 Adapters 072 adapter........................................................................... 154 L015 conduit adapter........................................................ 156 L015 threaded adapter...................................................... 153 L017 ring adapter................................................................ 153 L024 wide threaded adapter......................................... 153 Shrink boot adapter...........................................................120 Adapters, mounting LEAVYSEAL............................................................................ 70 AEC series.......................................................................... 85–90 AMPSEAL.............................................................................. 11–20 AMPSEAL 16 hybrid lever....................................................27 D B Backshells. See also Wire cover, Wire relief Circular DIN.............................................................................39 DRC series.............................................................................106 DTM series............................................................................. 126 DT series.........................................................................124–125 HD10 series............................................................................ 139 HD30/HDP20 series...................................................156–157 HDSCS........................................................................................51 LEAVYSEAL.............................................................................69 STRIKE series........................................................................ 165 Boots AEC series................................................................................89 DRB series................................................................................97 DRC series............................................................................. 107 DT/DTM/DTP series.................................................... 122–123 HD10 series............................................................................140 HD30/HDP20 series........................................................... 154 Breakaway connector HD30 series.................................................................. 153, 196 Bussing Options............................................................. 191–194 C CAN (Controller Area Network)...........................195–200 Contacts 1.0 mm.......................................................................................83 1.3 mm...................................................................................15–16 2.5 mm................................................................................ 39–41 AMP MCP..........................................................................53–55 DEUTSCH...................................................................... 169–180 HDSF 16............................................................................. 29–30 Coupling rings HD10 series............................................................................ 138 Covers Circular DIN.............................................................................38 Crimp General.................................................................................... 175 Inspection.............................................................................. 176 D hole punch........................................................................... 159 Dimensions AEC series................................................................................87 AMPSEAL..................................................................................13 AMPSEAL 16............................................................................23 Bussed feedback receptacles........................................ 193 Circular DIN.............................................................................37 Diodes & Resistors................................................... 208-208 DRB series................................................................................93 DRC series..............................................................................101 DT/DTM series....................................................................... 112 DTP series............................................................................... 113 DTHD series.......................................................................... 224 DTMH series.......................................................................... 129 DTV series............................................................................... 131 EEC enclosures.......................................................... 218, 220 HD10 series............................................................................ 135 HD30/HDP20 series........................................................... 147 HDSCS.......................................................................................47 Jiffy Splices.......................................................................... 227 LEAVYSEAL.............................................................................65 STRIKE series........................................................................ 163 Superseal 1.0............................................................................81 Diodes & Resistors..................................................... 205-208 DRB series........................................................................... 91–98 DRC series........................................................................ 99–108 DT/DTM/DTP series..................................................... 109–128 DTHD series...................................................................224–226 DTMH series............................................................................. 129 DTV series................................................................................. 131 Dust caps. See also Covers, Protection caps/covers AEC series................................................................................89 DT/DTM series...............................................................131–132 HD10 series............................................................................. 141 HD30/HDP20 series........................................................... 155 E EEC enclosures...............................................................218–221 End caps DT Series................................................................................. 119 “E” seal DT Series................................................................................. 119 Extraction tool. See also Removal tools Circular DIN............................................................................ 44 F Fixing slides HDSCS.......................................................................................52 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Index Topic Page Topic Page Flange modifications DTHD series.......................................................................... 225 DT series.................................................................................120 K Flanges DRB series............................................................................... 96 G Gaskets DRC series............................................................................. 107 DT/DTM/DTP series............................................................. 121 HD10 series............................................................................. 141 HD30/HDP20 series........................................................... 157 H HD10 series..................................................................... 133–144 HD30/HDP20 series.................................................... 145–160 I Insert/removal tools AMPSEAL 16............................................................................32 Circular DIN............................................................................ 44 DEUTSCH............................................................................... 187 HDSCS...................................................................................... 60 Instructions (How To) AEC series................................................................................89 AMPSEAL............................................................................18–19 AMPSEAL 16............................................................................33 Crimp sleeve reducer.........................................................180 DRB series.........................................................................97–98 DRC series............................................................................. 107 DT Family............................................................................... 132 DTT style hand tools.......................................................... 189 HD10 series............................................................................ 143 HD30/HDP20 series.................................................. 159–160 HDSCS................................................................................ 60–61 HDT-48-00 hand tool........................................................ 188 Jiffy Splice................................................................... 227–228 LEAVYSEAL.............................................................................78 Sealing plugs........................................................................ 179 STRIKE series................................................................166–167 Wire stripping....................................................................... 188 ISO box...................................................................................... 196 J J1939 J1939/11.......................................................................... 198–199 J1939/13........................................................................200–201 J1939/15....................................................................... 202–203 Jiffy Splices.................................................................... 227–228 Keying pins.............................................................................. 177 L Lanyards HD10 series............................................................................ 142 Locking slides LEAVYSEAL............................................................................ 70 Lockwashers HD30/HDP20 Series.......................................................... 157 M Material specifications AEC series................................................................................86 AMPSEAL..................................................................................13 Circular DIN.............................................................................36 DRB series................................................................................92 DRC series............................................................................ 100 DT Family................................................................................. 111 DTHD series.......................................................................... 224 HD10 series............................................................................ 134 HD30/HDP20 series........................................................... 147 HDSCS.......................................................................................47 LEAVYSEAL............................................................................ 64 STRIKE series........................................................................ 162 Superseal 1.0.......................................................................... 80 Modifications Descriptions............................................................... 230–238 059������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������� 154 072�������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������� 154 B010......................................................................................... 138 B016........................................................................................... 118 BL04........................................................................................120 BL08.........................................................................................120 BL10..........................................................................................120 BP03........................................................................................ 138 C015........................................................................................... 119 C030........................................................................................ 153 C041......................................................................................... 154 CE27.......................................................................................... 119 CE28.......................................................................................... 119 CL03.........................................................................................120 CL07.........................................................................................120 CL09........................................................................................120 CL20......................................................................................... 154 Detector................................................................................... 119 E003................................................................................119, 225 E004............................................................................... 120, 138 E005........................................................................................120 E007.........................................................................................120 E008........................................................................................120 EP13..........................................................................................194 EP14..........................................................................................194 L006........................................................................................ 154 PAGE 249 Index Topic Page Topic Page L009....................................................................................... 225 L012..........................................................................................120 L013......................................................................................... 225 L015.......................................................................................... 153 L017.......................................................................................... 153 L024......................................................................................... 153 LE01..........................................................................................120 LE05.........................................................................................120 LE06.........................................................................................120 LE07.........................................................................................120 LE08.........................................................................................120 LE09.........................................................................................120 LE10..........................................................................................120 LE11...........................................................................................120 LE12..........................................................................................120 LE14..........................................................................................120 LE17..........................................................................................120 LE21..........................................................................................120 N005........................................................................................ 138 P012........................................................................................... 119 P016..........................................................................................194 P021..........................................................................................194 P026.........................................................................................194 P027.........................................................................................194 P028.........................................................................................194 P030........................................................................................194 P031..........................................................................................194 P060........................................................................................194 P064........................................................................................149 P075.........................................................................................194 P080........................................................................................ 138 Mounting clips. See also Fixing slides, Locking slides AMPSEAL 16............................................................................26 DT/DTM/DTP series............................................................ 127 DTHD series.......................................................................... 226 Mounting ring Circular DIN.............................................................................39 DRC series............................................................................ 100 DT Family................................................................................. 111 HD10 series............................................................................ 134 HD30/HDP20 series...........................................................146 HDSCS...................................................................................... 46 HDSF 16.....................................................................................29 LEAVYSEAL............................................................................ 64 STRIKE series........................................................................ 162 Superseal 1.0.......................................................................... 80 Primary latch reinforcement (PLR)..................................24 Protection caps/covers HDSCS.......................................................................................52 LEAVYSEAL..............................................................................71 P Panel nut HD30/HDP20 series........................................................... 158 PCB pins.................................................................................... 174 PCB (Printed Circuit Board).................................. 209–222 Performance specifications 1.0 mm contacts.....................................................................83 1.3 mm contacts......................................................................15 2.5 mm contacts....................................................................39 AEC series................................................................................86 AMP MCP contacts.........................................................53, 71 AMPSEAL..................................................................................12 AMPSEAL 16............................................................................22 Circular DIN.............................................................................36 DEUTSCH contacts............................................................. 171 DRB series................................................................................92 S Sealing plugs AMPSEAL..................................................................................16 AMPSEAL 16.............................................................................31 Circular DIN.............................................................................42 DEUTSCH............................................................................... 178 HDSCS................................................................................56, 74 Superseal 1.0...........................................................................83 Shrink boot adapter DT/DTM series......................................................................120 Standards.................................................................................. 241 Strain relief DT series................................................................................. 124 HD10 series............................................................................140 HD30/HDP20 series...................................................155–156 Superseal 1.0..................................................................... 79–84 T Tooling Automated crimp tools AMPSEAL...............................................................................17 AMPSEAL 16.........................................................................32 Circular DIN..................................................................43–44 DEUTSCH................................................................... 182–184 HDSCS.............................................................. 58–59, 76–77 Superseal 1.0....................................................................... 84 DEUTSCH....................................................................... 181–190 Hand crimp tools AMPSEAL...............................................................................17 AMPSEAL 16..........................................................................31 Circular DIN..........................................................................42 DEUTSCH....................................................................185–186 HDSCS.............................................................................57, 75 Superseal 1.0....................................................................... 84 Removal tools AMPSEAL 16.........................................................................32 Circular DIN......................................................................... 44 DEUTSCH............................................................................ 187 HDSCS................................................................................... 60 INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS Index Topic Page Topic Page Tooling accessories..................................................... 183, 186 W Wedgelocks DRB series............................................................................... 96 DT/DTM/DTP series............................................................. 117 DTV series............................................................................... 131 Wire cover AMPSEAL 16............................................................................28 Wire relief AMPSEAL..................................................................................15 Wire router DRC series.............................................................................106 Wire sealing ranges AEC series................................................................................88 AMPSEAL..................................................................................15 AMPSEAL 16............................................................................25 DRB series................................................................................95 DRC series.............................................................................105 DT Family................................................................................ 116 HD10 series............................................................................ 137 HD30/HDP20 series........................................................... 152 STRIKE series........................................................................ 165 Wire seals Circular DIN.............................................................................42 HDSCS.......................................................................................56 LEAVYSEAL.............................................................................74 PAGE 251 NOTES: INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS LET’S CONNECT We make it easy to connect with our experts and are ready to provide all the support you need. For additional information or product assistance, please contact your field representative or our customer service department. Additional information is also available on the website http://www.te.com/usa-en/industries/ truck-bus-off-road-vehicles.html. TECHNICAL SUPPORT te.com/support-center Asia: +86 400-820-6015 Europe, Middle East, & Africa: +49 6251-133-0 North America: +1-888-441-9982 te.com TE Connectivity, TE connectivity (logo), LADD, EVERY CONNECTION COUNTS, AMP, AMP MCP, AMPSEAL, AMPSEAL 16, CERTI-CRIMP, CERTI-LOK, DETECTOR, DEUTSCH, ERGOCRIMP, LEAVYSEAL, PRO-CRIMPER, and STRIKE, are trademarks. USCAR is a trademark. All other logos, products and/or company names referred to herein might be trademarks of their respective owners. The information given herein, including drawings, illustrations and schematics which are intended for illustration purposes only, is believed to be reliable. However, TE Connectivity makes no warranties as to its accuracy or completeness and disclaims any liability in connection with its use. TE Connectivity‘s obligations shall only be as set forth in TE Connectivity‘s Standard Terms and Conditions of Sale for this product and in no case will TE Connectivity be liable for any incidental, indirect or consequential damages arising out of the sale, resale, use or misuse of the product. Users of TE Connectivity products should make their own evaluation to determine the suitability of each such product for the specific application. © 2015 TE Connectivity Ltd. family of companies All Rights Reserved. TS-ICT-T&CCAT  08/15   Original INDUSTRIAL & COMMERCIAL TRANSPORTATION /// TERMINALS AND CONNECTORS TE Connectivity 4849 Hempstead Station Drive Kettering, OH 45429 USA Tel: +1-888-441-9982 Fax: +1-937-312-9731 www.te.com
DT13-12PA
1. 物料型号:文档列出了多种型号的连接器,包括不同的接口类型和尺寸,例如3线16针、4/16线、5线16针等。

2. 器件简介:介绍了TE Connectivity的工业和商业运输终端和连接器,这些连接器设计用于在恶劣环境中保持数据和电源信号的完整性和连续性。

3. 引脚分配:详细列出了不同型号连接器的引脚分配,例如HD16-3-16S、HD14-3-16P等,以及它们的对应关系。

4. 参数特性:提供了连接器的电气性能规格,如电流承载能力、电压等级、绝缘电阻等。

5. 功能详解:解释了连接器的特定功能,如环境密封、抗振动、抗冲击等。

6. 应用信息:描述了连接器适用于哪些领域,如重型设备、运输行业等。

7. 封装信息:提供了连接器的物理尺寸和安装选项,如直插、90度弯插等。

8. 特殊修改:介绍了HD10系列连接器的特殊修改选项,如耦合环、连接器体颜色变化等。

9. 配件:列出了多种配件,如靴子、后壳、垫圈和保护帽,以增强设计灵活性和满足特定应用需求。

10. 安装说明:提供了详细的步骤,指导如何插入和移除连接器的接触件。
DT13-12PA 价格&库存

很抱歉,暂时无法提供与“DT13-12PA”相匹配的价格&库存,您可以联系我们找货

免费人工找货
DT13-12PA
    •  国内价格
    • 1+76.52880
    • 10+61.97040
    • 30+56.67840

    库存:1

    DT13-12PA
    •  国内价格 香港价格
    • 1+131.870881+16.35853
    • 10+101.4194410+12.58104
    • 25+91.7121925+11.37686
    • 50+85.1472750+10.56248
    • 100+79.19368100+9.82394
    • 250+72.17161250+8.95286
    • 500+67.44162500+8.36610
    • 1000+63.163311000+7.83538

    库存:543